blob: b44cb5f878435b84f9cf4ddd833d0288d3be9208 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau16216822012-09-10 09:46:55 +02007 2012/09/10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100627. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200637.1. Matching integers
647.2. Matching strings
657.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200667.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200677.5. Available matching criteria
687.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
697.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
707.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
717.6. Pre-defined ACLs
727.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100737.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074
758. Logging
768.1. Log levels
778.2. Log formats
788.2.1. Default log format
798.2.2. TCP log format
808.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100818.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200828.3. Advanced logging options
838.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
848.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
858.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
868.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
878.4. Timing events
888.5. Session state at disconnection
898.6. Non-printable characters
908.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
918.8. Capturing HTTP headers
928.9. Examples of logs
93
949. Statistics and monitoring
959.1. CSV format
969.2. Unix Socket commands
97
98
991. Quick reminder about HTTP
100----------------------------
101
102When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
103fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
104on almost anything found in the contents.
105
106However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
107formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
108correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
109
110
1111.1. The HTTP transaction model
112-------------------------------
113
114The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100115to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
117connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
118will involve a new connection :
119
120 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
121
122In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
123establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
124by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
125length.
126
127Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
128to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
129however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
130response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
131header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
132
133 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
134
135Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
136power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
137but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200138a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139
140A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
141keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
142second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
143page :
144
145 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
146
147This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
148latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
149correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
150the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100151server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200153By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
154connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
155everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
156established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
157sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
158while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
159another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
160sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
161http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
162mode.
163
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164
1651.2. HTTP request
166-----------------
167
168First, let's consider this HTTP request :
169
170 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100171 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
173 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
174 3 User-agent: my small browser
175 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
176 5 Accept: image/png
177
178
1791.2.1. The Request line
180-----------------------
181
182Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
183
184 - a METHOD : GET
185 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
186 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
187
188All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
189which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
190followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
191is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
192desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
193the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
194
195The URI itself can have several forms :
196
197 - A "relative URI" :
198
199 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
200
201 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
202 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
203
204 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
205
206 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
207
208 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
209 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
210 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
211 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
212 must accept this form too.
213
214 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
215 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
216 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
219 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
220 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
221 other protocols too.
222
223In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
224mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
225on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
226It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
227specific to the language, framework or application in use.
228
229
2301.2.2. The request headers
231--------------------------
232
233The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
234beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
235an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
236Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
237values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
238encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
239the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
240define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
241
242Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
243their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
244"Connection:" header).
245
246The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
247that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
248is one valid form of empty line.
249
250Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
251headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
252about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
253application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
254
255Important note:
256 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
257 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
258 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
259 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
260
261
2621.3. HTTP response
263------------------
264
265An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
266messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
267
268 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100269 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
271 2 Content-length: 350
272 3 Content-Type: text/html
273
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200274As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
275codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
276response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100277continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
278the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
279following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
280sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
281(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
282correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
283such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
284state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
285over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
286if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
287information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200289
2901.3.1. The Response line
291------------------------
292
293Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
294
295 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
296 - a status code : 200
297 - a reason : OK
298
299The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200300 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
302 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
303 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
304 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
305
306Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100307"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
309messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
310or "Authentication Required".
311
312Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
313
314 Code When / reason
315 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
316 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
317 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
318 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
319 400 for an invalid or too large request
320 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
321 accessing the stats page)
322 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
323 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
324 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
325 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
326 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
327 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
328 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
329 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
330 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
331
332The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3334.2).
334
335
3361.3.2. The response headers
337---------------------------
338
339Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
340the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
341details.
342
343
3442. Configuring HAProxy
345----------------------
346
3472.1. Configuration file format
348------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200349
350HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
351
352 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
353 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
354 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
355 "frontend" and "backend".
356
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
358referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
359delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100360preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100361escaped by doubling them.
362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363
3642.2. Time format
365----------------
366
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100367Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100368values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
369otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
370numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
371for every keyword. Supported units are :
372
373 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
374 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
375 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
376 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
377 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
378 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
379
380
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003812.3. Examples
382-------------
383
384 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
385 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
386 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
387 global
388 daemon
389 maxconn 256
390
391 defaults
392 mode http
393 timeout connect 5000ms
394 timeout client 50000ms
395 timeout server 50000ms
396
397 frontend http-in
398 bind *:80
399 default_backend servers
400
401 backend servers
402 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
403
404
405 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
406 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
407 global
408 daemon
409 maxconn 256
410
411 defaults
412 mode http
413 timeout connect 5000ms
414 timeout client 50000ms
415 timeout server 50000ms
416
417 listen http-in
418 bind *:80
419 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
420
421
422Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
423
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100424 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200425
426
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004273. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200428--------------------
429
430Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
431are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
432of them have command-line equivalents.
433
434The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
435
436 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200437 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200439 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200440 - daemon
441 - gid
442 - group
443 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100444 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200445 - nbproc
446 - pidfile
447 - uid
448 - ulimit-n
449 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200450 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200451 - node
452 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100453 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100454
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 * Performance tuning
456 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200457 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100458 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200459 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200460 - noepoll
461 - nokqueue
462 - nopoll
463 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100464 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200465 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200466 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200467 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200468 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100469 - tune.maxaccept
470 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200471 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200472 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100473 - tune.rcvbuf.client
474 - tune.rcvbuf.server
475 - tune.sndbuf.client
476 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100477
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200478 * Debugging
479 - debug
480 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200481
482
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004833.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200484------------------------------------
485
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200486ca-base <dir>
487 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
488 relative path is used with "cafile" or "crlfile" directives. Absolute
489 locations specified in "cafile" and "crlfile" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
490
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200491chroot <jail dir>
492 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
493 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
494 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
495 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
496 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
497 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100498
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200499crt-base <dir>
500 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
501 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
502 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
503
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200504daemon
505 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
506 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
507 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
508
509gid <number>
510 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
511 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
512 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
513 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100514
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200515group <group name>
516 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
517 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100518
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200519log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200520 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
521 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100522 configured with "log global".
523
524 <address> can be one of:
525
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100526 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100527 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
528 port).
529
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100530 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
531 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
532 port).
533
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100534 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
535 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
536 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
537 writeable).
538
539 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540
541 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
542 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
543 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
544
545 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200546 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
547 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
548 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
549 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
550 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
551 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200552
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200553 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200554
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100555log-send-hostname [<string>]
556 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
557 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
558 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
559 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
560 the logs.
561
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000562log-tag <string>
563 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
564 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
565 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
566 running on the same host.
567
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200568nbproc <number>
569 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
570 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
571 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
572 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
573 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
574
575pidfile <pidfile>
576 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
577 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
578 starting the process. See also "daemon".
579
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200580stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
581 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
582 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
583 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
584 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200585
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200586 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
587 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
588 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200589
590stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
591 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
592 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100593 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200594
595stats maxconn <connections>
596 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
597 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
598
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200599uid <number>
600 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
601 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
602 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
603 one. See also "gid" and "user".
604
605ulimit-n <number>
606 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
607 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
608 option.
609
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100610unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
611 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
612
613 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
614 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
615 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
616 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
617 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
618 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
619 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
620 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
621 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
622 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
623
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200624user <user name>
625 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
626 See also "uid" and "group".
627
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200628node <name>
629 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
630
631 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
632 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
633 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
634 traffic.
635
636description <text>
637 Add a text that describes the instance.
638
639 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
640 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
641 "<" and ">" characters.
642
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200643
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006443.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645-----------------------
646
647maxconn <number>
648 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
649 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
650 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
651 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
652
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200653maxconnrate <number>
654 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
655 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
656 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
657 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
658 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
659 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
660 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
661 fairness.
662
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100663maxpipes <number>
664 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
665 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
666 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
667 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
668 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
669 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
670
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200671maxsslconn <number>
672 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
673 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
674 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
675 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
676 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
677 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
678 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
679
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200680noepoll
681 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
682 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
683 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
684
685nokqueue
686 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
687 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
688 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
689
690nopoll
691 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
692 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100693 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200694 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
695 "nokqueue".
696
697nosepoll
698 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
699 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
700 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
701
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100702nosplice
703 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
704 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
705 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100706 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100707 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
708 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
709 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
710 "option splice-response".
711
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200712spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
713 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
714 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
715 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
716 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
717 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
718
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200719tune.bufsize <number>
720 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
721 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
722 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
723 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
724 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
725 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
726 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
727 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
728
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200729tune.chksize <number>
730 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
731 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
732 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
733 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
734 checks whenever possible.
735
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200736tune.http.maxhdr <number>
737 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
738 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
739 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
740 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
741 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
742 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
743 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
744 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
745 limit too high.
746
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100747tune.maxaccept <number>
748 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
749 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
750 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100751 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100752 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
753 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100754 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100755 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
756
757tune.maxpollevents <number>
758 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
759 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
760 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
761 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
762 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
763
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200764tune.maxrewrite <number>
765 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
766 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
767 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
768 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
769 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
770 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
771 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
772 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
773 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
774 bufsize.
775
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200776tune.pipesize <number>
777 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
778 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
779 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
780 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
781 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
782 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
783
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100784tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
785tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
786 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
787 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
788 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
789 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
790 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
791 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
792 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
793
794tune.sndbuf.client <number>
795tune.sndbuf.server <number>
796 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
797 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
798 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
799 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
800 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
801 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
802 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
803 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
804 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
805 notifying haproxy again.
806
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200807
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008083.3. Debugging
809--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200810
811debug
812 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
813 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
814 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
815 system startup.
816
817quiet
818 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
819 line argument "-q".
820
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200821
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008223.4. Userlists
823--------------
824It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
825http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
826it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
827
828userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100829 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100830 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
831
832group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100833 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100834 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
835 proceeded by "users" keyword.
836
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100837user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
838 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100839 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
840 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100841 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
842 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100843 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
844 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
845
846
847 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100848 userlist L1
849 group G1 users tiger,scott
850 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100851
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100852 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
853 user scott insecure-password elgato
854 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100855
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100856 userlist L2
857 group G1
858 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100859
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100860 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
861 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
862 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100863
864 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200865
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200866
8673.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200868----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200869It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
870haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
871pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
872identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
873or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
874Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
875known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
876the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
877process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
878during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
879tables.
880
881peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400882 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200883 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
884
885peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
886 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
887 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
888 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
889 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
890 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
891 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
892
893 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
894 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
895
896 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
897 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
898 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
899 across all peers.
900
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200901 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200902 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100903 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
904 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
905 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200906
907 backend mybackend
908 mode tcp
909 balance roundrobin
910 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
911 stick on src
912
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100913 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
914 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200915
916
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009174. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200918----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100919
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200920Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
921 - defaults <name>
922 - frontend <name>
923 - backend <name>
924 - listen <name>
925
926A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
927its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
928section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100929section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200930
931A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
932connections.
933
934A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
935to forward incoming connections.
936
937A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
938parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
939
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100940All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
941'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
942case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
943
944Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
945logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
946proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
947However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
948name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
949
950Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
951and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100952bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100953protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
954modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
955arbitrary criteria.
956
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
959--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100960
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200961The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
962limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
963they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
964limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100965marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200966option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200967and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
968with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
969specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100970
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200971
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100972 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
973------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
974acl - X X X
975appsession - - X X
976backlog X X X -
977balance X - X X
978bind - X X -
979bind-process X X X X
980block - X X X
981capture cookie - X X -
982capture request header - X X -
983capture response header - X X -
984clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
985contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
986cookie X - X X
987default-server X - X X
988default_backend X X X -
989description - X X X
990disabled X X X X
991dispatch - - X X
992enabled X X X X
993errorfile X X X X
994errorloc X X X X
995errorloc302 X X X X
996-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
997errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200998force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100999fullconn X - X X
1000grace X X X X
1001hash-type X - X X
1002http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001003http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001004http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001005http-request - X X X
1006id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001007ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001008log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001009maxconn X X X -
1010mode X X X X
1011monitor fail - X X -
1012monitor-net X X X -
1013monitor-uri X X X -
1014option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1015option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1016option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1017option allbackups (*) X - X X
1018option checkcache (*) X - X X
1019option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1020option contstats (*) X X X -
1021option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1022option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1023option forceclose (*) X X X X
1024-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1025option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001026option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001027option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001028option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1029option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1030option httpchk X - X X
1031option httpclose (*) X X X X
1032option httplog X X X X
1033option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001034option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001035option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001036option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1037option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1038option logasap (*) X X X -
1039option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001040option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001041option nolinger (*) X X X X
1042option originalto X X X X
1043option persist (*) X - X X
1044option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001045option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001046option smtpchk X - X X
1047option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1048option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1049option splice-request (*) X X X X
1050option splice-response (*) X X X X
1051option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1052option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1053-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1054option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1055option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1056option tcpka X X X X
1057option tcplog X X X X
1058option transparent (*) X - X X
1059persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1060rate-limit sessions X X X -
1061redirect - X X X
1062redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1063redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1064reqadd - X X X
1065reqallow - X X X
1066reqdel - X X X
1067reqdeny - X X X
1068reqiallow - X X X
1069reqidel - X X X
1070reqideny - X X X
1071reqipass - X X X
1072reqirep - X X X
1073reqisetbe - X X X
1074reqitarpit - X X X
1075reqpass - X X X
1076reqrep - X X X
1077-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1078reqsetbe - X X X
1079reqtarpit - X X X
1080retries X - X X
1081rspadd - X X X
1082rspdel - X X X
1083rspdeny - X X X
1084rspidel - X X X
1085rspideny - X X X
1086rspirep - X X X
1087rsprep - X X X
1088server - - X X
1089source X - X X
1090srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001091stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001092stats auth X - X X
1093stats enable X - X X
1094stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001095stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001096stats realm X - X X
1097stats refresh X - X X
1098stats scope X - X X
1099stats show-desc X - X X
1100stats show-legends X - X X
1101stats show-node X - X X
1102stats uri X - X X
1103-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1104stick match - - X X
1105stick on - - X X
1106stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001107stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001108stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001109tcp-request connection - X X -
1110tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001111tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001112tcp-response content - - X X
1113tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001114timeout check X - X X
1115timeout client X X X -
1116timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1117timeout connect X - X X
1118timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1119timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1120timeout http-request X X X X
1121timeout queue X - X X
1122timeout server X - X X
1123timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1124timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001125timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001126transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001127unique-id-format X X X -
1128unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001129use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001130use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001131------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1132 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001133
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001134
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011354.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1136---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001137
1138This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1139
1140
1141acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1142 Declare or complete an access list.
1143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1144 no | yes | yes | yes
1145 Example:
1146 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1147 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1148 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1149
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001150 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001151
1152
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001153appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1154 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001155 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1157 no | no | yes | yes
1158 Arguments :
1159 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1160 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1161
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001162 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001163 checked in each cookie value.
1164
1165 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1166 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1167 milliseconds.
1168
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001169 request-learn
1170 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1171 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1172 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1173 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1174 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1175 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1176
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001177 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1178 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1179 data following this prefix.
1180
1181 Example :
1182 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1183
1184 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1185 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1186
1187 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1188 2 modes are currently supported :
1189 - path-parameters :
1190 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1191 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1192 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1193 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1194 - query-string :
1195 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1196 query string.
1197
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001198 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1199 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1200 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1201 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001202 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1203 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1204 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001205 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1206 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1207
1208 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1209
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001210 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1211 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1212 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1213
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001214 Example :
1215 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1216
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001217 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1218 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001219
1220
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001221backlog <conns>
1222 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1224 yes | yes | yes | no
1225 Arguments :
1226 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1227 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001228 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001229
1230 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1231 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1232 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1233 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1234 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1235 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1236 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1237 backlog parameter.
1238
1239 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1240 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1241 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1242
1243 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1244
1245
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001246balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001247balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001248 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1250 yes | no | yes | yes
1251 Arguments :
1252 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1253 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1254 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1255 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1256
1257 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1258 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1259 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1260 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001261 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1262 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1263 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1264 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1265 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1266 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1267 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1268 it, so that you don't worry.
1269
1270 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1271 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1272 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1273 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1274 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1275 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1276 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1277 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001278
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001279 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1280 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1281 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1282 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1283 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1284 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1285 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1286 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1287
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001288 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1289 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1290 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1291 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001292 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001293 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1294 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1295 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1296 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1297 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001298 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1299 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1300 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1301 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1302 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1303 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001304
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001305 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1306 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1307 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1308 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1309 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1310 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1311 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1312 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001313 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001314 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001315 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1316 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1317 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001318
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001319 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1320 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1321 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1322 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1323 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1324 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1325 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1326 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1327 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1328 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1329 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1330 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001331
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001332 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001333 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1334 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1335 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1336 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1337 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1338 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1339 URIs start with a leading "/".
1340
1341 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1342 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1343 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1344 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1345
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001346 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001347 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1348
1349 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001350 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1351 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1352 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1353 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1354 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1355 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1356 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1357 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1358 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1359 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1360 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1361 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1362 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1363 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1364 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1365 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1366 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1367 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1368 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001369
1370 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1371 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1372 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1373 server will receive the request.
1374
1375 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1376 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1377 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1378 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1379 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001380 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1381 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1382 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001383
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001384 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1385 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1386 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1387 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1388 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001389
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001390 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001391 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1392 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1393 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1394
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001395 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1396 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1397 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1398
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001399 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001400 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001401 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1402 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1403 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1404 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1405 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1406 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001407 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001408 used instead.
1409
1410 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1411 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1412 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1413 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1414
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001415 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1416 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1417 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1418
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001419 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001420
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001421 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001422 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1423 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001424
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001425 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001426 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001427
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001428 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1429 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1430 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001431
1432 Examples :
1433 balance roundrobin
1434 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001435 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001436 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1437 balance hdr(host)
1438 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001439
1440 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1441 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1442
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001443 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001444 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1445 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1446 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1447 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1448
1449 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1450 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1451 defaults to 16 kB.
1452
1453 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1454 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1455
1456 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1457 Round Robin.
1458
1459 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1460 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1461 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1462 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1463
1464 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1465
1466 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001467 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001468 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1469 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1470 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001471
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001472 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1473 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001474
1475
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001476bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1477bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001478 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1480 no | yes | yes | no
1481 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001482 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1483 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1484 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1485 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001486 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001487
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001488 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1489 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001490 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1491 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1492 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001493 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1494 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1495 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1496 the range.
1497
1498 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1499 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1500 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1501 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1502 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1503 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1504 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001505 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001506 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001507
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001508 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1509 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1510 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1511 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1512 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1513 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1514 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1515 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1516
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001517 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1518 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1519 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1520 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001521
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001522 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1523 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1524 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1525 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1526 in a frontend.
1527
1528 Example :
1529 listen http_proxy
1530 bind :80,:443
1531 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001532 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001533
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001534 listen http_https_proxy
1535 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001536 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001537
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001538 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001539 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001540
1541
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001542bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1543 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1545 yes | yes | yes | yes
1546 Arguments :
1547 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1548 may be used to override a default value.
1549
1550 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1551 option may be combined with other numbers.
1552
1553 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1554 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1555 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1556 missing from all processes.
1557
1558 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1559 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1560 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1561 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1562
1563 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1564 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1565 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1566 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1567 and 'even' instances.
1568
1569 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1570 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1571 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1572 32.
1573
1574 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1575 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1576
1577 Example :
1578 listen app_ip1
1579 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001580 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001581
1582 listen app_ip2
1583 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001584 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001585
1586 listen management
1587 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001588 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001589
1590 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1591
1592
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001593block { if | unless } <condition>
1594 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1596 no | yes | yes | yes
1597
1598 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1599 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001600 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001601 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001602 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1603 "block" statements per instance.
1604
1605 Example:
1606 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1607 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1608 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1609 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1610
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001611 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001612
1613
1614capture cookie <name> len <length>
1615 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1617 no | yes | yes | no
1618 Arguments :
1619 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1620 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1621 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1622 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1623 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1624
1625 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1626 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1627 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1628 right if it exceeds <length>.
1629
1630 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1631 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1632 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1633 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1634
1635 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1636 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1637 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1638
1639 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1640 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1641 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1642 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001643 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001644 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1645
1646 Example:
1647 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1648
1649 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001650 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001651
1652
1653capture request header <name> len <length>
1654 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1656 no | yes | yes | no
1657 Arguments :
1658 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001659 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001660 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1661 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1662 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1663
1664 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1665 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1666 it exceeds <length>.
1667
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001668 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001669 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1670 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001671 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1672 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1673 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1674 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001675 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001676 environments to find where the request came from.
1677
1678 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1679 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1680 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1681 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001682
1683 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1684 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1685 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1686 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1687
1688 Example:
1689 capture request header Host len 15
1690 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1691 capture request header Referrer len 15
1692
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001693 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001694 about logging.
1695
1696
1697capture response header <name> len <length>
1698 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1700 no | yes | yes | no
1701 Arguments :
1702 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001703 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001704 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1705 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1706 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1707
1708 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1709 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1710 it exceeds <length>.
1711
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001712 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001713 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1714 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1715 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001716 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1717 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1718 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1719 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001720
1721 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1722 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1723 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1724 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1725
1726 Example:
1727 capture response header Content-length len 9
1728 capture response header Location len 15
1729
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001730 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001731 about logging.
1732
1733
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001734clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001735 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1737 yes | yes | yes | no
1738 Arguments :
1739 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1740 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1741 as explained at the top of this document.
1742
1743 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1744 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1745 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1746 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1747 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1748 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1749 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1750 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001751 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001752 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1753 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1754
1755 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1756 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1757 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1758 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1759 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1760 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1761
1762 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1763 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1764
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001765 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1766 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001767
1768
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001769contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001770 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1772 yes | no | yes | yes
1773 Arguments :
1774 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1775 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1776 as explained at the top of this document.
1777
1778 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001779 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001780 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001781 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1782 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1783 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1784 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1785
1786 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1787 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1788 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1789 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1790 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1791 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1792
1793 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1794 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1795 instead.
1796
1797 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1798 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1799
1800
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001801cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001802 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
1803 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001804 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1806 yes | no | yes | yes
1807 Arguments :
1808 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1809 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1810 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1811 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1812 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1813 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1814 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1815 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1816 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1817
1818 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1819 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1820 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1821 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1822 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1823 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1824 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1825 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1826 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1827 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1828 "insert" and "prefix".
1829
1830 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001831 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001832
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001833 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001834 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1835 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1836 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1837 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1838 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1839 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1840 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1841 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1842 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1843 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001844
1845 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1846 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1847 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1848 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1849 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1850 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1851 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1852 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1853 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1854 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001855 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
1856 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
1857 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001858
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001859 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1860 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1861 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001862 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1863 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1864 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1865 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001866 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
1867 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
1868 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001869
1870 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1871 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1872 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1873 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1874 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1875 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1876 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1877 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1878 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1879
1880 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1881 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1882 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1883 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1884 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1885 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1886 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1887 persistence cookie in the cache.
1888 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1889
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001890 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1891 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1892 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1893 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1894 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1895 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1896 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1897 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1898 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1899 they logout.
1900
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001901 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
1902 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
1903 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
1904 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
1905
1906 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
1907 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
1908 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
1909 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
1910 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
1911 this attribute.
1912
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001913 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001914 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001915 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1916 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1917 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1918 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1919 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1920 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001921
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001922 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
1923 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
1924 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
1925 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
1926 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
1927 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
1928 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
1929 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1930 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
1931 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
1932 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
1933 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
1934 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
1935 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
1936 the site.
1937
1938 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
1939 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
1940 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
1941 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
1942 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
1943 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
1944 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
1945 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
1946 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
1947 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
1948 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
1949 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
1950 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1951 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
1952 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
1953 redispatch after some absolute delay.
1954
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001955 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
1956 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
1957 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
1958 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001959
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001960 Examples :
1961 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
1962 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
1963 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001964 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001965
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02001966 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001967 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001968
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001969
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001970default-server [param*]
1971 Change default options for a server in a backend
1972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1973 yes | no | yes | yes
1974 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001975 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1976 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1977 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1978 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001979
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001980 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001981 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
1982
1983 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001984
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001985
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001986default_backend <backend>
1987 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
1988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1989 yes | yes | yes | no
1990 Arguments :
1991 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
1992
1993 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
1994 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
1995 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
1996 will catch all undetermined requests.
1997
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001998 Example :
1999
2000 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2001 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2002 default_backend dynamic
2003
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002004 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2005
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002006
2007disabled
2008 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2010 yes | yes | yes | yes
2011 Arguments : none
2012
2013 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2014 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2015 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2016 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2017 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2018 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2019 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2020
2021 See also : "enabled"
2022
2023
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002024dispatch <address>:<port>
2025 Set a default server address
2026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2027 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002028 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002029
2030 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2031 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2032 during start-up.
2033
2034 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2035 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2036 possible with normal servers.
2037
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002038 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002039 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2040 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2041 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2042 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2043
2044 See also : "server"
2045
2046
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002047enabled
2048 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2050 yes | yes | yes | yes
2051 Arguments : none
2052
2053 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2054 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2055
2056 See also : "disabled"
2057
2058
2059errorfile <code> <file>
2060 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2062 yes | yes | yes | yes
2063 Arguments :
2064 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002065 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002066
2067 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002068 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002069 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002070 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2071 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002072
2073 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2074 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2075 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2076
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002077 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2078
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002079 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2080 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2081 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2082 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2083
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002084 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2085 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2086 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2087 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2088 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2089 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2090
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002091 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2092 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2093 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002094 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002095 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2096
2097 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2098
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002099 Example :
2100 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2101 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2102 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2103
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002104
2105errorloc <code> <url>
2106errorloc302 <code> <url>
2107 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2109 yes | yes | yes | yes
2110 Arguments :
2111 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002112 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002113
2114 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2115 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2116 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2117 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2118 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2119
2120 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2121 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2122 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2123
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002124 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2125
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002126 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2127 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2128 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2129 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2130 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2131 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2132 request.
2133
2134 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2135
2136
2137errorloc303 <code> <url>
2138 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2140 yes | yes | yes | yes
2141 Arguments :
2142 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2143 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2144
2145 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2146 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2147 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2148 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2149 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2150
2151 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2152 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2153 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2154
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002155 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2156
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002157 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2158 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2159 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2160 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002161 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002162
2163 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2164
2165
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002166force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2167 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2168 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2169 no | yes | yes | yes
2170
2171 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2172 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2173 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2174 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2175 marked down for maintenance operations.
2176
2177 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2178 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2179 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2180 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2181 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2182 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2183 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2184 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2185 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2186
2187 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2188 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2189 is used.
2190
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002191 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002192 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002193
2194
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002195fullconn <conns>
2196 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2198 yes | no | yes | yes
2199 Arguments :
2200 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2201 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2202
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002203 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002204 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002205 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002206 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2207 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2208 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2209 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2210 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002211 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002212
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002213 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2214 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2215 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2216
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002217 Example :
2218 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2219 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2220 # connections.
2221 backend dynamic
2222 fullconn 10000
2223 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2224 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2225
2226 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2227
2228
2229grace <time>
2230 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002232 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002233 Arguments :
2234 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2235 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2236 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2237
2238 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2239 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002240 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002241 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2242
2243 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2244 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2245 simplify it.
2246
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002247
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002248hash-type <method>
2249 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2251 yes | no | yes | yes
2252 Arguments :
2253 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2254 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2255 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2256 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2257 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2258 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2259 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2260 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2261 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2262
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002263 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2264 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2265 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2266 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2267 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2268 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2269 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2270 this value.
2271
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002272 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2273 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2274 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2275 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2276 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2277 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2278 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2279 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2280 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2281 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2282 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2283 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2284 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2285
2286 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2287
2288 See also : "balance", "server"
2289
2290
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002291http-check disable-on-404
2292 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002294 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002295 Arguments : none
2296
2297 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2298 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2299 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2300 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2301 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2302 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2303 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2304 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002305 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2306 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2307 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2308
2309 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2310
2311
2312http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002313 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002315 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002316 Arguments :
2317 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2318 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002319 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002320 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2321 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2322 details on the supported keywords.
2323
2324 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2325 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2326 with the usual backslash ('\').
2327
2328 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2329 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2330 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2331 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2332 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2333
2334 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002335 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002336 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2337 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2338 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2339
2340 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002341 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002342 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2343 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2344 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2345 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2346
2347 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002348 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002349 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2350 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2351 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2352 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2353 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2354 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2355 trace).
2356
2357 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002358 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002359 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2360 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2361 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2362 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2363 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2364 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2365
2366 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2367 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2368 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2369 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2370 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2371 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2372 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2373 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2374
2375 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2376 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2377
2378 Examples :
2379 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002380 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002381
2382 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002383 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002384
2385 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002386 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002387
2388 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002389 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002390
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002391 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002392
2393
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002394http-check send-state
2395 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2397 yes | no | yes | yes
2398 Arguments : none
2399
2400 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2401 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2402 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2403 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2404 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2405
2406 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2407 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2408 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2409 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2410 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2411 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2412 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2413 checked in multiple backends.
2414
2415 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2416 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2417
2418 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2419 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2420 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2421 one fails.
2422
2423 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2424 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2425 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2426
2427 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2428 server's queue.
2429
2430 Example of a header received by the application server :
2431 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2432 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2433
2434 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2435
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002436http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002437 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002438 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2439
2440 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2441 no | yes | yes | yes
2442
2443 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2444 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2445 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002446 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2447 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002448 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2449
2450 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2451 instance.
2452
2453 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002454 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2455 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2456 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002457
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002458 http-request allow if nagios
2459 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2460 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2461 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002462
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002463 Example:
2464 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002465
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002466 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002467
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002468 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2469 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002470
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002471http-send-name-header [<header>]
2472 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2473
2474 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2475 yes | no | yes | yes
2476
2477 Arguments :
2478
2479 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2480
2481 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2482 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2483 is added with the header string proved.
2484
2485 See also : "server"
2486
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002487id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002488 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2490 no | yes | yes | yes
2491 Arguments : none
2492
2493 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2494 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2495 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002496
2497
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002498ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2499 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2500 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2501 no | yes | yes | yes
2502
2503 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2504 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2505 and running).
2506
2507 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2508 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2509 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2510 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2511 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2512
2513 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2514 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2515
2516 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2517 "unless" condition is met.
2518
2519 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2520
2521
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002522log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002523log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002524no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002525 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2527 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002528
2529 Prefix :
2530 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2531 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2532 prefix does not allow arguments.
2533
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002534 Arguments :
2535 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2536 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2537 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2538 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2539 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2540 parameter.
2541
2542 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2543 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2544
2545 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2546 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2547 standard syslog port).
2548
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002549 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2550 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2551 standard syslog port).
2552
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002553 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2554 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2555 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2556 appropriately writeable).
2557
2558 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2559
2560 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2561 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2562 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2563
2564 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2565 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2566 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002567 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2568 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2569 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2570 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2571 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002572
2573 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2574
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002575 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2576 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2577 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002578
2579 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2580 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2581 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2582 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2583
2584 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2585 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002586
2587 Example :
2588 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002589 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2590 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002591
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002592log-format <string>
2593 Allows you to custom a log line.
2594
2595 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2596
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002597
2598maxconn <conns>
2599 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2601 yes | yes | yes | no
2602 Arguments :
2603 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2604 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2605 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2606 closes.
2607
2608 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2609 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2610 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2611 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2612 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2613 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2614 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2615 properly tuned.
2616
2617 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2618 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2619 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2620
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02002621 By default, this value is set to 2000.
2622
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002623 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2624
2625
2626mode { tcp|http|health }
2627 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2629 yes | yes | yes | yes
2630 Arguments :
2631 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2632 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2633 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2634 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2635
2636 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2637 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2638 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2639 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2640 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2641
2642 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002643 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
2644 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
2645 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
2646 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
2647 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
2648 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
2649 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002650
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002651 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2652 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2653 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002654
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002655 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002656 defaults http_instances
2657 mode http
2658
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002659 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002660
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002661
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002662monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002663 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2665 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002666 Arguments :
2667 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2668 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002669 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002670 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2671 backend and its backup.
2672
2673 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2674 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2675 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2676 servers in a list of backends.
2677
2678 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2679 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2680 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2681 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2682 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2683 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2684 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002685 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2686 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002687
2688 Example:
2689 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002690 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002691 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2692 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2693 monitor-uri /site_alive
2694 monitor fail if site_dead
2695
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002696 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002697
2698
2699monitor-net <source>
2700 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2702 yes | yes | yes | no
2703 Arguments :
2704 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2705 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2706 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2707 followed by a mask.
2708
2709 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2710 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002711 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002712 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2713
2714 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2715 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2716 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2717 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002718 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
2719 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
2720 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002721
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002722 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
2723 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
2724 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
2725 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
2726 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
2727 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002728
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002729 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2730 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002731
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002732 Example :
2733 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2734 frontend www
2735 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2736
2737 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2738
2739
2740monitor-uri <uri>
2741 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2743 yes | yes | yes | no
2744 Arguments :
2745 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2746 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2747
2748 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2749 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2750 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2751 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2752 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2753 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2754 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2755 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2756
2757 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2758 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2759 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2760 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2761 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2762 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2763
2764 Example :
2765 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2766 frontend www
2767 mode http
2768 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2769
2770 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2771
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002772
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002773option abortonclose
2774no option abortonclose
2775 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2777 yes | no | yes | yes
2778 Arguments : none
2779
2780 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2781 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2782 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2783 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002784 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002785 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2786 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2787 encountered while delivering the response.
2788
2789 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2790 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2791 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2792 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2793 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2794 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002795 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002796 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002797 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002798 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2799 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2800 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2801
2802 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2803 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2804 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2805 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2806 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2807 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2808 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2809 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002810 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002811
2812 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2813 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2814
2815 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2816
2817
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002818option accept-invalid-http-request
2819no option accept-invalid-http-request
2820 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2822 yes | yes | yes | no
2823 Arguments : none
2824
2825 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2826 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2827 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2828 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2829 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2830 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2831 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2832 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002833 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
2834 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
2835 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
2836 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
2837 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
2838 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002839
2840 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2841 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2842 been confirmed.
2843
2844 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2845 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002846 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
2847 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002848 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2849
2850 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2851 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2852
2853 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2854 stats socket.
2855
2856
2857option accept-invalid-http-response
2858no option accept-invalid-http-response
2859 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2861 yes | no | yes | yes
2862 Arguments : none
2863
2864 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2865 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2866 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2867 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2868 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2869 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2870 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2871 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2872 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2873
2874 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2875 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2876 been confirmed.
2877
2878 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2879 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2880 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2881 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2882
2883 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2884 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2885
2886 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2887 stats socket.
2888
2889
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002890option allbackups
2891no option allbackups
2892 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2894 yes | no | yes | yes
2895 Arguments : none
2896
2897 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2898 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2899 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2900 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2901 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2902 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2903 order between the backup servers anymore.
2904
2905 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2906 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2907
2908 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2909 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2910
2911
2912option checkcache
2913no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002914 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2916 yes | no | yes | yes
2917 Arguments : none
2918
2919 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2920 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002921 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002922 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2923 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002924 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002925
2926 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002927 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002928 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002929 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2930 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002931 to the client are :
2932 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002933 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002934 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002935 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
2936 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
2937 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
2938 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
2939 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
2940 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
2941 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
2942 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
2943 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
2944 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
2945 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
2946
2947 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002948 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002949 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002950 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002951 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
2952
2953 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
2954 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002955 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002956 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
2957
2958 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2959 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2960
2961
2962option clitcpka
2963no option clitcpka
2964 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
2965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2966 yes | yes | yes | no
2967 Arguments : none
2968
2969 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
2970 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
2971 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
2972 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
2973
2974 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
2975 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
2976 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
2977 operating system and its tuning parameters.
2978
2979 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
2980 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
2981 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
2982 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
2983 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
2984
2985 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
2986
2987 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
2988 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
2989 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
2990
2991 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2992 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2993
2994 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
2995
2996
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002997option contstats
2998 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
2999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3000 yes | yes | yes | no
3001 Arguments : none
3002
3003 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3004 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3005 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3006 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3007 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3008 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3009 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3010
3011
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003012option dontlog-normal
3013no option dontlog-normal
3014 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3016 yes | yes | yes | no
3017 Arguments : none
3018
3019 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3020 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3021 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3022 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3023 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3024 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3025 logged.
3026
3027 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3028 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3029 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3030
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003031 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003032 logging.
3033
3034
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003035option dontlognull
3036no option dontlognull
3037 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3039 yes | yes | yes | no
3040 Arguments : none
3041
3042 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3043 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3044 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3045 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3046 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3047 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3048 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3049
3050 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3051 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3052 would not be logged.
3053
3054 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3055 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3056
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003057 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003058
3059
3060option forceclose
3061no option forceclose
3062 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003064 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003065 Arguments : none
3066
3067 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3068 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3069 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3070 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3071 global session times in the logs.
3072
3073 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003074 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003075 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3076 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3077 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3078 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003079
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003080 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3081 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3082 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3083
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003084 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3085 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3086
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003087 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003088
3089
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003090option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003091 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3093 yes | yes | yes | yes
3094 Arguments :
3095 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3096 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003097 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003098 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003099
3100 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3101 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3102 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3103 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3104 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3105 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3106 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003107 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3108 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3109 possible that the client has already brought one.
3110
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003111 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003112 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003113 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3114 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003115 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3116 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003117
3118 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3119 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3120 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3121 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3122 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3123 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3124 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3125
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003126 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3127 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3128 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3129 are under the control of the end-user.
3130
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003131 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003132 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3133 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003134 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3135 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3136 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003137
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003138 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3139 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3140 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3141 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3142 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003143
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003144 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003145 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3146 frontend www
3147 mode http
3148 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3149
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003150 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3151 backend www
3152 mode http
3153 option forwardfor header X-Client
3154
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003155 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3156 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003157
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003158
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003159option http-no-delay
3160no option http-no-delay
3161 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3163 yes | yes | yes | yes
3164 Arguments : none
3165
3166 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3167 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3168 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3169 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3170 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3171 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3172 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3173 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3174 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3175 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3176 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3177 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3178 affected.
3179
3180 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3181 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3182 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3183 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3184 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3185 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3186 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3187 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3188 latency environments.
3189
3190
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003191option http-pretend-keepalive
3192no option http-pretend-keepalive
3193 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3195 yes | yes | yes | yes
3196 Arguments : none
3197
3198 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3199 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3200 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3201 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3202 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3203 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3204 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3205 consider the response complete.
3206
3207 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3208 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3209 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3210 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3211 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3212 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3213
3214 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3215 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3216 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3217 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3218 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3219 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3220 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3221
3222 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3223 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003224 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003225 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3226 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003227
3228 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3229 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3230
3231 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3232
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003233
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003234option http-server-close
3235no option http-server-close
3236 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3238 yes | yes | yes | yes
3239 Arguments : none
3240
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003241 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3242 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3243 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3244 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3245 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3246 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3247 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3248 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3249 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3250 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3251 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3252 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003253
3254 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3255 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3256 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3257 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003258 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3259 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003260
3261 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3262 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003263 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3264 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3265 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003266
3267 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3268 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3269
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003270 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3271 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003272
3273
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003274option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003275no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003276 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3278 yes | yes | yes | no
3279 Arguments : none
3280
3281 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3282 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3283 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3284 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3285 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3286 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3287 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3288
3289 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3290 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3291 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3292 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3293 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3294 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3295 request along its whole life.
3296
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003297 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3298 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3299 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3300 front of an existing proxy.
3301
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003302 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3303
3304 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3305 http-server-close".
3306
3307
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003308option httpchk
3309option httpchk <uri>
3310option httpchk <method> <uri>
3311option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3312 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3314 yes | no | yes | yes
3315 Arguments :
3316 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3317 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3318 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3319 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3320 ones.
3321
3322 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3323 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3324 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3325
3326 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3327 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3328 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3329 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3330 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3331
3332 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3333 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3334 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3335 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3336 the lack of any response.
3337
3338 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3339
3340 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3341 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3342 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3343
3344 Examples :
3345 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3346 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3347 backend https_relay
3348 mode tcp
3349 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3350 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3351
3352 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003353 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3354 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003355
3356
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003357option httpclose
3358no option httpclose
3359 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3361 yes | yes | yes | yes
3362 Arguments : none
3363
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003364 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3365 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3366 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3367 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3368 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3369 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3370 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003371
3372 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003373 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003374 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3375 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3376 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3377 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3378 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003379
3380 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3381 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3382 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003383 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3384 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003385
3386 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3387 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3388
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003389 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3390 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003391
3392
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003393option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003394 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3396 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003397 Arguments :
3398 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3399 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3400 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3401 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3402 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003403
3404 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3405 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3406 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3407 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3408 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3409 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3410 ports.
3411
3412 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3413
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003414 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3415 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3416 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3417 by default.
3418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003419 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003420
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003421
3422option http_proxy
3423no option http_proxy
3424 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3426 yes | yes | yes | yes
3427 Arguments : none
3428
3429 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3430 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3431 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3432 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3433 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3434
3435 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3436 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3437 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3438 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003439 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003440 be analyzed.
3441
3442 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3443 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3444
3445 Example :
3446 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3447 backend direct_forward
3448 option httpclose
3449 option http_proxy
3450
3451 See also : "option httpclose"
3452
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003453
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003454option independent-streams
3455no option independent-streams
3456 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3458 yes | yes | yes | yes
3459 Arguments : none
3460
3461 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3462 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3463 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3464 receive data or not.
3465
3466 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3467 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3468 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3469 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3470 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3471 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3472 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3473 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3474 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3475 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3476 socket buffers.
3477
3478 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3479 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3480 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3481 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3482 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3483
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003484 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3485 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3486 deprecated.
3487
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003488 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003489
3490
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003491option ldap-check
3492 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3494 yes | no | yes | yes
3495 Arguments : none
3496
3497 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3498 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3499 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3500 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3501
3502 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3503 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3504
3505 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3506 configure it.
3507
3508 Example :
3509 option ldap-check
3510
3511 See also : "option httpchk"
3512
3513
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003514option log-health-checks
3515no option log-health-checks
3516 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3518 yes | no | yes | yes
3519 Arguments : none
3520
3521 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3522 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3523 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3524 of additional information is limited.
3525
3526 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3527 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3528
3529 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3530
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003531
3532option log-separate-errors
3533no option log-separate-errors
3534 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3536 yes | yes | yes | no
3537 Arguments : none
3538
3539 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3540 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3541 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3542 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3543 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3544 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3545 provides very important information.
3546
3547 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3548 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3549 error logs.
3550
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003551 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003552 logging.
3553
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003554
3555option logasap
3556no option logasap
3557 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3559 yes | yes | yes | no
3560 Arguments : none
3561
3562 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3563 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3564 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3565 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3566 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3567 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3568 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003569 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003570 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3571 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3572
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003573 Examples :
3574 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3575 mode http
3576 option httplog
3577 option logasap
3578 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3579
3580 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3581 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3582 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3583 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3584
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003585 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003586 logging.
3587
3588
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003589option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3590 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3592 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003593 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003594 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
3595 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003596
3597 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3598 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3599 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3600 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3601 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3602 in the MySQL table, like this :
3603
3604 USE mysql;
3605 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3606 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3607
3608 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3609 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3610 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3611 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3612 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3613 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3614 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3615 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3616 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3617
3618 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3619 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003620
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003621 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003622
3623 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3624 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3625 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3626 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3627 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3628 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3629
3630 See also: "option httpchk"
3631
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003632option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3633 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3635 yes | no | yes | yes
3636 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003637 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
3638 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003639
3640 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3641 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3642 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3643 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3644
3645 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003646
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003647option nolinger
3648no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003649 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003650 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3651 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003652 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003653
3654 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3655 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3656 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3657 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3658 connections.
3659
3660 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3661 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3662 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3663 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3664 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3665 this too.
3666
3667 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3668 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3669 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3670
3671 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3672 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3673 for servers.
3674
3675 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3676 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3677
3678
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003679option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3680 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3682 yes | yes | yes | yes
3683 Arguments :
3684 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3685 matching <network>
3686 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3687 header name.
3688
3689 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3690 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3691 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3692 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3693 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3694 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3695 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3696 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3697 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3698 possible that the client has already brought one.
3699
3700 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3701 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3702 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3703 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3704 header and requires different one.
3705
3706 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3707 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3708 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3709 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3710 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3711 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3712 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3713
3714 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3715 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3716 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3717 both are defined.
3718
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003719 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3720 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3721 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3722 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3723 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003724
3725 Examples :
3726 # Original Destination address
3727 frontend www
3728 mode http
3729 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3730
3731 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3732 backend www
3733 mode http
3734 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3735
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003736 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3737 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003738
3739
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003740option persist
3741no option persist
3742 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3743 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3744 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003745 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003746
3747 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3748 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3749 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3750 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3751 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3752 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3753 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3754 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3755 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3756 redirected to another valid server.
3757
3758 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3759 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3760
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003761 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003762
3763
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003764option redispatch
3765no option redispatch
3766 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3767 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3768 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003769 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003770
3771 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3772 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3773 be able to access the service anymore.
3774
3775 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3776 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3777
3778 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3779 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3780 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003781
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003782 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3783 "redisp" keywords.
3784
3785 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3786 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3787
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003788 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003789
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003790
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003791option redis-check
3792 Use redis health checks for server testing
3793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3794 yes | no | yes | yes
3795 Arguments : none
3796
3797 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3798 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3799 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3800 find the "+PONG" response message.
3801
3802 Example :
3803 option redis-check
3804
3805 See also : "option httpchk"
3806
3807
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003808option smtpchk
3809option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3810 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3812 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003813 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003814 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3815 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3816 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3817
3818 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3819 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3820 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3821
3822 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3823 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3824 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3825 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3826 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3827 dead server.
3828
3829 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3830 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3831 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3832 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3833
3834 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3835 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3836 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3837 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3838 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3839
3840 Example :
3841 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3842
3843 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3844
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003845
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003846option socket-stats
3847no option socket-stats
3848
3849 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3851 yes | yes | yes | no
3852
3853 Arguments : none
3854
3855
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003856option splice-auto
3857no option splice-auto
3858 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3860 yes | yes | yes | yes
3861 Arguments : none
3862
3863 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3864 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3865 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3866 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003867 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003868 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3869 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3870 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3871 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3872
3873 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3874 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3875 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3876 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3877 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3878 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3879 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3880 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3881 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3882 keyword.
3883
3884 Example :
3885 option splice-auto
3886
3887 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3888 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3889
3890 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3891 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3892
3893
3894option splice-request
3895no option splice-request
3896 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3898 yes | yes | yes | yes
3899 Arguments : none
3900
3901 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003902 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003903 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3904 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3905 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3906 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3907
3908 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3909
3910 Example :
3911 option splice-request
3912
3913 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3914 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3915
3916 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3917 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3918
3919
3920option splice-response
3921no option splice-response
3922 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3924 yes | yes | yes | yes
3925 Arguments : none
3926
3927 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003928 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003929 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3930 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3931 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3932 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3933
3934 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3935
3936 Example :
3937 option splice-response
3938
3939 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3940 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3941
3942 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
3943 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3944
3945
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003946option srvtcpka
3947no option srvtcpka
3948 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
3949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3950 yes | no | yes | yes
3951 Arguments : none
3952
3953 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3954 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3955 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3956 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3957
3958 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3959 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3960 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3961 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3962
3963 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3964 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3965 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3966 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3967 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3968
3969 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3970
3971 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3972 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3973 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
3974
3975 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3976 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3977
3978 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
3979
3980
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003981option ssl-hello-chk
3982 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
3983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3984 yes | no | yes | yes
3985 Arguments : none
3986
3987 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
3988 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
3989 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
3990 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
3991 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
3992 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
3993 hello message.
3994
3995 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
3996 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
3997 messages, which is appreciable.
3998
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02003999 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4000 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4001 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004002
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004003 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4004
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004005
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004006option tcp-smart-accept
4007no option tcp-smart-accept
4008 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4010 yes | yes | yes | no
4011 Arguments : none
4012
4013 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4014 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4015 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4016 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4017 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4018 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4019
4020 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4021 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4022 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4023 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4024
4025 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4026 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4027 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4028 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4029
4030 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4031 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4032 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4033
4034 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4035 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4036 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4037
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004038 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4039
4040
4041option tcp-smart-connect
4042no option tcp-smart-connect
4043 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4045 yes | no | yes | yes
4046 Arguments : none
4047
4048 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4049 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4050 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4051 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4052 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4053
4054 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4055 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4056 complex.
4057
4058 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4059 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4060 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4061
4062 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4063 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4064
4065 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4066
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004067
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004068option tcpka
4069 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4071 yes | yes | yes | yes
4072 Arguments : none
4073
4074 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4075 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4076 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4077 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4078
4079 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4080 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4081 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4082 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4083
4084 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4085 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4086 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4087 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4088 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4089
4090 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4091
4092 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4093 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4094 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4095 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4096 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4097 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4098 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4099 backends.
4100
4101 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4102
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004103
4104option tcplog
4105 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4107 yes | yes | yes | yes
4108 Arguments : none
4109
4110 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4111 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4112 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4113 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4114 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4115 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4116 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4117 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4118
4119 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4120
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004121 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004122
4123
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004124option transparent
4125no option transparent
4126 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004128 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004129 Arguments : none
4130
4131 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4132 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4133 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4134 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4135 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4136 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4137 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4138 appropriate server.
4139
4140 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4141 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4142
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004143 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004144 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004145
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004146
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004147persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004148persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004149 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4151 yes | no | yes | yes
4152 Arguments :
4153 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004154 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4155 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004156
4157 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4158 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4159 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4160 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4161 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4162 forwarded to this server.
4163
4164 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4165 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4166 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004167 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004168 a single "listen" section.
4169
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004170 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4171 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4172 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4173
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004174 Example :
4175 listen tse-farm
4176 bind :3389
4177 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4178 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4179 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4180 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4181 persist rdp-cookie
4182 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004183 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004184 balance rdp-cookie
4185 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4186 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4187
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004188 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4189 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004190
4191
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004192rate-limit sessions <rate>
4193 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4195 yes | yes | yes | no
4196 Arguments :
4197 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4198 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4199
4200 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4201 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4202 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4203 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4204 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4205 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4206
4207 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4208 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4209 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4210 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4211
4212 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4213 listen smtp
4214 mode tcp
4215 bind :25
4216 rate-limit sessions 10
4217 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4218
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004219 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4220 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4221 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004222
4223 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4224
4225
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004226redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4227redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4228redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004229 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4231 no | yes | yes | yes
4232
4233 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004234 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004235
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004236 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004237 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
4238 the HTTP "Location" header.
4239
4240 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4241 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4242 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4243 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4244 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
4245 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie).
4246
4247 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4248 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4249 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4250 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4251 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4252 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4253 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4254 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
4255 HTTPS.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004256
4257 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4258 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4259 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4260 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4261 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4262 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4263 location with a GET method.
4264
4265 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4266 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4267
4268 - "drop-query"
4269 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4270 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4271 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4272 with a location-type redirect.
4273
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004274 - "append-slash"
4275 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4276 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4277 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4278 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4279
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004280 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4281 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4282 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4283 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4284 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4285 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4286 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4287
4288 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4289 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4290 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4291 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4292 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4293 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4294 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004295
4296 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4297 acl clear dst_port 80
4298 acl secure dst_port 8080
4299 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004300 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004301 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004302 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4303
4304 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004305 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4306 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4307 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004308 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004309
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004310 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4311 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4312 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4313
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004314 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
4315 redirect scheme https if !{ is_ssl }
4316
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004317 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004318
4319
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004320redisp (deprecated)
4321redispatch (deprecated)
4322 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4323 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4324 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004325 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004326
4327 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4328 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4329 be able to access the service anymore.
4330
4331 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4332 redistribute them to a working server.
4333
4334 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4335 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4336 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004337
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004338 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4339 "option redispatch" instead.
4340
4341 See also : "option redispatch"
4342
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004343
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004344reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004345 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4347 no | yes | yes | yes
4348 Arguments :
4349 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4350 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004351 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004352
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004353 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4354 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4355
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004356 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4357 the last header of an HTTP request.
4358
4359 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4360 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4361 responses.
4362
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004363 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4364 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4365 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4366
4367 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4368 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004369
4370
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004371reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4372reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004373 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4375 no | yes | yes | yes
4376 Arguments :
4377 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4378 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4379 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4380 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4381 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4382 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4383 ignores case.
4384
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004385 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4386 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4387
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004388 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4389 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4390 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4391 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004392 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004393
4394 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4395 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4396
4397 Example :
4398 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4399 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4400 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4401
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004402 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4403 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004404
4405
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004406reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4407reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004408 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4410 no | yes | yes | yes
4411 Arguments :
4412 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4413 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4414 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4415 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4416 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4417 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4418
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004419 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4420 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4421
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004422 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4423 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4424 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4425 next servers.
4426
4427 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4428 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4429 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4430
4431 Example :
4432 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4433 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4434 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4435
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004436 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4437 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004438
4439
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004440reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4441reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004442 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4444 no | yes | yes | yes
4445 Arguments :
4446 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4447 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4448 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4449 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4450 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4451 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4452 case.
4453
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004454 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4455 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4456
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004457 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4458 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4459 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4460 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004461 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004462
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004463 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004464 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004465 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004466
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004467 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4468 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4469
4470 Example :
4471 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4472 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4473 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4474
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004475 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4476 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004477
4478
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004479reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4480reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004481 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4483 no | yes | yes | yes
4484 Arguments :
4485 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4486 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4487 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4488 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4489 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4490 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4491 case.
4492
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004493 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4494 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4495
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004496 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4497 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4498 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4499 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4500
4501 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4502 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4503
4504 Example :
4505 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4506 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4507 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4508 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4509
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004510 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4511 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004512
4513
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004514reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4515reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004516 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4518 no | yes | yes | yes
4519 Arguments :
4520 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4521 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4522 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4523 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4524 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4525 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4526
4527 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4528 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4529 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4530 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004531 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004532
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004533 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4534 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4535
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004536 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4537 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4538 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4539
4540 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4541 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4542 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4543 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4544 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4545
4546 Example :
4547 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04004548 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004549 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4550 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4551
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004552 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4553 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004554
4555
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004556reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4557reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004558 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4560 no | yes | yes | yes
4561 Arguments :
4562 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4563 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4564 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4565 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4566 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4567 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4568 ignores case.
4569
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004570 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4571 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4572
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004573 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4574 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004575 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4576 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4577 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004578 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4579 not set.
4580
4581 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4582 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4583 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4584 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4585 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4586
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004587 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004588 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4589 # block all others.
4590 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4591 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4592
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004593 # block bad guys
4594 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4595 reqitarpit . if badguys
4596
4597 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4598 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004599
4600
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004601retries <value>
4602 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4603 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4604 yes | no | yes | yes
4605 Arguments :
4606 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4607 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4608 default value is 3.
4609
4610 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4611 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4612 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4613
4614 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4615 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4616
4617 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4618 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4619
4620 See also : "option redispatch"
4621
4622
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004623rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004624 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4626 no | yes | yes | yes
4627 Arguments :
4628 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4629 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004630 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004631
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004632 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4633 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4634
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004635 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4636 the last header of an HTTP response.
4637
4638 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4639 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4640 responses.
4641
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004642 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4643 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004644
4645
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004646rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4647rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004648 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4650 no | yes | yes | yes
4651 Arguments :
4652 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4653 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4654 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4655 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4656 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4657 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4658 ignores case.
4659
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004660 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4661 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4662
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004663 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4664 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004665 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004666 client.
4667
4668 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4669 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4670 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4671
4672 Example :
4673 # remove the Server header from responses
4674 reqidel ^Server:.*
4675
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004676 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4677 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004678
4679
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004680rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4681rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004682 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4684 no | yes | yes | yes
4685 Arguments :
4686 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4687 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4688 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4689 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4690 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4691 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4692 ignores case.
4693
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004694 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4695 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4696
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004697 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4698 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4699 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4700 case-sensitive.
4701
4702 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004703 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4704 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4705 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004706
4707 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4708 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4709
4710 Example :
4711 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4712 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4713
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004714 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4715 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004716
4717
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004718rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4719rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004720 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4722 no | yes | yes | yes
4723 Arguments :
4724 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4725 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4726 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4727 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4728 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4729 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4730 ignores case.
4731
4732 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4733 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4734 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4735 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004736 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004737
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004738 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4739 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4740
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004741 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4742 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4743 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4744
4745 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4746 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4747 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4748 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4749 are not case-sensitive.
4750
4751 Example :
4752 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4753 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4754
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004755 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4756 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004757
4758
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004759server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004760 Declare a server in a backend
4761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4762 no | no | yes | yes
4763 Arguments :
4764 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004765 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-server-name" is
4766 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004767
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004768 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4769 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4770 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4771 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004772 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4773 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4774 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4775 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4776 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4777 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004778
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004779 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004780 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4781 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4782 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4783 adding this value to the client's port.
4784
4785 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4786 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004787 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004788
4789 Examples :
4790 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4791 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4792
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004793 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
4794 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004795
4796
4797source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004798source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004799source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004800 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4802 yes | no | yes | yes
4803 Arguments :
4804 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4805 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4806 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4807 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4808
4809 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4810 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004811 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4812 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4813 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004814
4815 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4816 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4817 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4818 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4819 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4820 <addr>.
4821
4822 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4823 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4824 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4825 port.
4826
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004827 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4828 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4829 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4830 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4831 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4832 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4833 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4834 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4835 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4836 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4837 HTTP header.
4838
4839 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4840 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004841 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004842 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4843 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4844 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4845 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4846 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4847 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4848 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4849
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004850 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4851 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4852 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4853 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4854 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4855 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4856
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004857 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4858 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4859 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4860 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4861
4862 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4863 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4864 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4865 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4866 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4867 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4868
4869 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4870 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4871 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4872 there are two methods :
4873
4874 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4875 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4876 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4877 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4878 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4879 of the client ranges may be used.
4880
4881 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4882 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4883 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4884 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4885 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4886 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4887 same session.
4888
4889 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4890 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4891 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4892 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4893 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4894 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4895
4896 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4897 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4898 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004899 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004900
4901 Examples :
4902 backend private
4903 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4904 source 192.168.1.200
4905
4906 backend transparent_ssl1
4907 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4908 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4909
4910 backend transparent_ssl2
4911 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4912 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4913 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4914
4915 backend transparent_ssl3
4916 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4917 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4918 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4919
4920 backend transparent_smtp
4921 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4922 # with Tproxy version 4.
4923 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4924
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004925 backend transparent_http
4926 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4927 # proxy.
4928 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4929
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004930 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004931 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4932
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004933
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004934srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4935 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4937 yes | no | yes | yes
4938 Arguments :
4939 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4940 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4941 as explained at the top of this document.
4942
4943 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4944 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4945 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4946 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4947 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4948 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4949 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
4950
4951 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
4952 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
4953 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
4954 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
4955 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004956 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004957 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004958 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004959
4960 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
4961 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
4962 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
4963 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
4964 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
4965 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
4966
4967 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
4968 Please use "timeout server" instead.
4969
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004970 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
4971 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004972
4973
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004974stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
4975 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
4976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4977 no | no | yes | yes
4978
4979 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
4980 matched.
4981
4982 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
4983 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
4984
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01004985 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
4986 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
4987 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
4988
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01004989 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
4990 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
4991 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
4992 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004993
4994 Example :
4995 # statistics admin level only for localhost
4996 backend stats_localhost
4997 stats enable
4998 stats admin if LOCALHOST
4999
5000 Example :
5001 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5002 backend stats_auth
5003 stats enable
5004 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5005 stats admin if TRUE
5006
5007 Example :
5008 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5009 userlist stats-auth
5010 group admin users admin
5011 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5012 group readonly users haproxy
5013 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5014
5015 backend stats_auth
5016 stats enable
5017 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5018 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5019 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5020 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5021
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005022 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5023 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5024 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005025
5026
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005027stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5028 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5030 yes | no | yes | yes
5031 Arguments :
5032 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5033
5034 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5035
5036 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5037 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5038 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5039 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5040 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5041 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5042
5043 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5044 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5045 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005046 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005047
5048 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5049 report using "stats scope".
5050
5051 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5052 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5053 unobvious parameters.
5054
5055 Example :
5056 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5057 backend public_www
5058 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5059 stats enable
5060 stats hide-version
5061 stats scope .
5062 stats uri /admin?stats
5063 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5064 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5065 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5066
5067 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5068 backend private_monitoring
5069 stats enable
5070 stats uri /admin?stats
5071 stats refresh 5s
5072
5073 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5074
5075
5076stats enable
5077 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5079 yes | no | yes | yes
5080 Arguments : none
5081
5082 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5083 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5084 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5085 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5086 - stats auth : no authentication
5087 - stats scope : no restriction
5088
5089 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5090 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5091 unobvious parameters.
5092
5093 Example :
5094 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5095 backend public_www
5096 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5097 stats enable
5098 stats hide-version
5099 stats scope .
5100 stats uri /admin?stats
5101 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5102 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5103 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5104
5105 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5106 backend private_monitoring
5107 stats enable
5108 stats uri /admin?stats
5109 stats refresh 5s
5110
5111 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5112
5113
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005114stats hide-version
5115 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5117 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005118 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005119
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005120 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5121 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5122 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5123 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5124 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5125 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005126
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005127 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5128 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5129 unobvious parameters.
5130
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005131 Example :
5132 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5133 backend public_www
5134 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005135 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005136 stats hide-version
5137 stats scope .
5138 stats uri /admin?stats
5139 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5140 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5141 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005142
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005143 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5144 backend private_monitoring
5145 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005146 stats uri /admin?stats
5147 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005148
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005149 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005150
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005151
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005152stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5153 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5154 Access control for statistics
5155
5156 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5157 no | no | yes | yes
5158
5159 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5160 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5161 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5162 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5163 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5164 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5165
5166 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5167 instance.
5168
5169 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5170 about ACL usage.
5171
5172
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005173stats realm <realm>
5174 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5176 yes | no | yes | yes
5177 Arguments :
5178 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5179 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5180 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5181
5182 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5183 using a backslash ('\').
5184
5185 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5186 only related to authentication.
5187
5188 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5189 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5190 unobvious parameters.
5191
5192 Example :
5193 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5194 backend public_www
5195 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5196 stats enable
5197 stats hide-version
5198 stats scope .
5199 stats uri /admin?stats
5200 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5201 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5202 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5203
5204 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5205 backend private_monitoring
5206 stats enable
5207 stats uri /admin?stats
5208 stats refresh 5s
5209
5210 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5211
5212
5213stats refresh <delay>
5214 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5216 yes | no | yes | yes
5217 Arguments :
5218 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5219 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5220 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5221 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5222 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5223 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5224
5225 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5226 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5227 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5228 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5229
5230 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5231 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5232 unobvious parameters.
5233
5234 Example :
5235 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5236 backend public_www
5237 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5238 stats enable
5239 stats hide-version
5240 stats scope .
5241 stats uri /admin?stats
5242 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5243 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5244 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5245
5246 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5247 backend private_monitoring
5248 stats enable
5249 stats uri /admin?stats
5250 stats refresh 5s
5251
5252 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5253
5254
5255stats scope { <name> | "." }
5256 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5258 yes | no | yes | yes
5259 Arguments :
5260 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5261 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5262 section in which the statement appears.
5263
5264 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5265 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5266 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5267 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5268 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5269 exists.
5270
5271 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5272 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5273 unobvious parameters.
5274
5275 Example :
5276 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5277 backend public_www
5278 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5279 stats enable
5280 stats hide-version
5281 stats scope .
5282 stats uri /admin?stats
5283 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5284 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5285 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5286
5287 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5288 backend private_monitoring
5289 stats enable
5290 stats uri /admin?stats
5291 stats refresh 5s
5292
5293 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5294
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005295
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005296stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005297 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5299 yes | no | yes | yes
5300
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005301 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005302 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5303
5304 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5305 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5306
5307 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5308 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005309 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005310
5311 Example :
5312 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5313 backend private_monitoring
5314 stats enable
5315 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5316 stats uri /admin?stats
5317 stats refresh 5s
5318
5319 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5320 global section.
5321
5322
5323stats show-legends
5324 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5325 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5326 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5327 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5328 - IP (socket, server)
5329 - cookie (backend, server)
5330
5331 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5332 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005333 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005334
5335 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5336
5337
5338stats show-node [ <name> ]
5339 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5341 yes | no | yes | yes
5342 Arguments:
5343 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5344 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5345
5346 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5347 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005348 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005349
5350 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5351 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5352 unobvious parameters.
5353
5354 Example:
5355 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5356 backend private_monitoring
5357 stats enable
5358 stats show-node Europe-1
5359 stats uri /admin?stats
5360 stats refresh 5s
5361
5362 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5363 section.
5364
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005365
5366stats uri <prefix>
5367 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5369 yes | no | yes | yes
5370 Arguments :
5371 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5372 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5373 query string.
5374
5375 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5376 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5377 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5378 possible to reach it in the application.
5379
5380 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005381 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005382 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5383 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5384 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5385 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5386
5387 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5388 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5389 an address or a port to statistics only.
5390
5391 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5392 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5393 unobvious parameters.
5394
5395 Example :
5396 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5397 backend public_www
5398 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5399 stats enable
5400 stats hide-version
5401 stats scope .
5402 stats uri /admin?stats
5403 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5404 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5405 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5406
5407 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5408 backend private_monitoring
5409 stats enable
5410 stats uri /admin?stats
5411 stats refresh 5s
5412
5413 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5414
5415
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005416stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5417 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005419 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005420
5421 Arguments :
5422 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5423 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5424 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5425 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5426
5427 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5428 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5429 the "stick-table" statement.
5430
5431 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5432 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5433 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5434 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5435 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5436
5437 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5438 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5439 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5440 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5441 transformation rules.
5442
5443 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5444 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5445 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5446 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5447 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5448 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5449 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5450
5451 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5452 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5453 ACL based conditions.
5454
5455 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5456 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5457 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5458 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5459
5460 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5461 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5462 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5463 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5464
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005465 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5466 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5467 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5468
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005469 Example :
5470 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5471 # last 30 minutes
5472 backend pop
5473 mode tcp
5474 balance roundrobin
5475 stick store-request src
5476 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5477 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5478 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5479
5480 backend smtp
5481 mode tcp
5482 balance roundrobin
5483 stick match src table pop
5484 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5485 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5486
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005487 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5488 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005489
5490
5491stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5492 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5494 no | no | yes | yes
5495
5496 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5497 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5498 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5499 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5500
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005501 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5502 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5503 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5504
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005505 Examples :
5506 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005507 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005508
5509 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5510 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5511 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5512
5513
5514 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5515 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5516 backend http
5517 mode http
5518 balance roundrobin
5519 stick on src table https
5520 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5521 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5522 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5523
5524 backend https
5525 mode tcp
5526 balance roundrobin
5527 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5528 stick on src
5529 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5530 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5531
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005532 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005533
5534
5535stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5536 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5538 no | no | yes | yes
5539
5540 Arguments :
5541 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5542 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5543 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5544 server is selected.
5545
5546 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5547 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5548 the "stick-table" statement.
5549
5550 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5551 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5552 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5553 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5554 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5555 address.
5556
5557 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5558 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5559 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5560 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5561 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5562 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5563 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5564 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5565 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5566 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5567
5568 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5569 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5570 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5571 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5572 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5573 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5574 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5575
5576 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5577 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5578 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5579 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5580
5581 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5582 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5583 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5584 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5585 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5586 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5587 another protocol or access method.
5588
5589 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5590 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5591 the request.
5592
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005593 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5594 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5595 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5596
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005597 Example :
5598 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5599 # last 30 minutes
5600 backend pop
5601 mode tcp
5602 balance roundrobin
5603 stick store-request src
5604 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5605 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5606 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5607
5608 backend smtp
5609 mode tcp
5610 balance roundrobin
5611 stick match src table pop
5612 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5613 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5614
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005615 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5616 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005617
5618
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005619stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005620 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5621 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005622 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005624 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005625
5626 Arguments :
5627 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5628 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5629 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5630 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5631
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005632 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5633 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5634 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5635 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5636
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005637 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5638 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5639 instance.
5640
5641 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5642 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5643 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5644 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5645 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5646 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005647 to 32 characters.
5648
5649 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5650 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5651 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5652 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5653 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5654 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005655
5656 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005657 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5658 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005659 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5660 increase.
5661
5662 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005663 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5664 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5665 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005666
5667 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5668 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5669 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5670 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5671 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5672 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5673 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5674 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5675 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5676 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5677 parameter (see below).
5678
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005679 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5680 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5681 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5682 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5683 soft restart.
5684
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005685 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5686
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005687 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5688 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5689 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5690 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5691 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005692 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005693 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5694 if not expiration delay is specified.
5695
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005696 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5697 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5698 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5699 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005700 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5701 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5702 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5703 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5704 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5705 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5706 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5707 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5708 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5709 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5710 types and their arguments.
5711
5712 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5713 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5714 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5715 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5716
5717 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5718 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5719 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5720 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5721
5722 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5723 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5724 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5725 they were received.
5726
5727 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5728 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5729 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5730 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5731 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5732
5733 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5734 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5735 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5736 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5737 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5738
5739 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5740 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5741 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5742
5743 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5744 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5745 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5746 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5747 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5748
5749 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5750 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5751 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5752 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5753 the client side.
5754
5755 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5756 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5757 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5758 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5759 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5760 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5761 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5762
5763 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5764 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5765 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5766 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5767 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5768 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5769 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5770
5771 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5772 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5773 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5774 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5775 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5776 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5777
5778 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5779 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5780 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5781 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5782
5783 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5784 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5785 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5786 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5787 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5788 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5789 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5790 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5791 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5792 recommended for better fairness.
5793
5794 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5795 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5796 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5797 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5798
5799 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5800 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5801 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5802 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5803 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5804 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5805 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5806 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5807 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5808 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005809
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005810 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5811 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005812 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5813 reference it.
5814
5815 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5816 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5817 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5818 as an exclusive stickiness.
5819
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005820 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5821 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5822 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5823 something that can be ignored.
5824
5825 Example:
5826 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5827 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5828 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5829 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5830
5831 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005832 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005833
5834
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005835stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5836 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5838 no | no | yes | yes
5839
5840 Arguments :
5841 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5842 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5843 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5844 server is selected.
5845
5846 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5847 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5848 the "stick-table" statement.
5849
5850 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5851 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5852 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5853 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5854
5855 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5856 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5857 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5858 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5859 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5860 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005861 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005862 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5863 rules.
5864
5865 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5866 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5867 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5868 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5869 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5870 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5871 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5872
5873 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5874 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5875 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5876 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5877
5878 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5879 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5880 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5881 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5882 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5883 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5884 another protocol or access method.
5885
5886 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5887
5888 Example :
5889 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5890 backend https
5891 mode tcp
5892 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005893 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005894 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005895
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005896 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5897 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5898
5899 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5900 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5901 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5902
5903 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5904 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005905
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005906 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5907 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5908 # at offset 44.
5909
5910 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5911 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5912
5913 # Learn on response if server hello.
5914 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005915
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005916 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5917 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5918
5919 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5920 extraction.
5921
5922
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005923tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5924 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5926 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005927 Arguments :
5928 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5929 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5930 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005931
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005932 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005933
5934 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5935 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005936 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5937 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5938 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5939 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5940 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5941 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005942
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005943 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5944 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5945 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5946 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005947
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005948 Three types of actions are supported :
5949 - accept :
5950 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5951 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5952 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005953
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005954 - reject :
5955 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5956 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5957 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
5958 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
5959 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
5960 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
5961 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
5962 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
5963 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
5964 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
5965 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
5966 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005967
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005968 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
5969 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
5970 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
5971 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
5972 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
5973 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
5974 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
5975 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
5976 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005977
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005978 These actions take one or two arguments :
5979 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
5980 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
5981 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005982
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005983 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
5984 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
5985 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
5986 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005987
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005988 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
5989 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
5990 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
5991 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
5992 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
5993 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
5994 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
5995 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
5996 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
5997 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005998
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005999 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6000 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6001 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006002
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006003 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6004 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6005 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006006
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006007 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006008 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006009 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006010
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006011 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6012 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6013 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006014
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006015 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6016 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6017 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006018
6019 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6020
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006021 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006022
6023
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006024tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6025 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006027 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006028 Arguments :
6029 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6030 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6031 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006032
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006033 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006034
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006035 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6036 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6037 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6038 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6039 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006040
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006041 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6042 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6043 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6044 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6045 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6046 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6047 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6048 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6049 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006050
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006051 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6052 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6053 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6054 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006055
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006056 Three types of actions are supported :
6057 - accept :
6058 - reject :
6059 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006060
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006061 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6062 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006063
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006064 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6065 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6066 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6067 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6068 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6069 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006070
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006071 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006072 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6073 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006074
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006075 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006076 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6077 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6078 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6079 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6080 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006081
6082 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006083 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6084 # and reject everything else.
6085 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6086 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006087 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006088 tcp-request content reject
6089
6090 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006091 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6092 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6093 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006094 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006095
6096 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6097 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6098 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006099 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006100 tcp-request content reject
6101
6102 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6103 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6104
6105 frontend http
6106 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6107 # protecting all our sites
6108 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6109 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6110 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6111 ...
6112 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6113
6114 backend http_dynamic
6115 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6116 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6117 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6118 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6119 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6120 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6121 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006122
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006123 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006124
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006125 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006126
6127
6128tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6129 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006131 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006132 Arguments :
6133 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6134 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6135 as explained at the top of this document.
6136
6137 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6138 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6139 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6140 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6141 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6142
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006143 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6144 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6145 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6146 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6147
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006148 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6149 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006150 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006151 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006152 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6153 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6154 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6155 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006156
6157 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6158 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6159 it pass through unaffected.
6160
6161 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6162 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6163 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006164 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006165 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6166 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006167 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6168 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6169 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006170
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006171 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006172 "timeout client".
6173
6174
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006175tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6176 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6178 no | no | yes | yes
6179 Arguments :
6180 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6181 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6182 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6183
6184 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6185
6186 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6187 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6188 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6189 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006190 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006191
6192 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6193
6194 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6195 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6196 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6197 inserted.
6198
6199 Two types of actions are supported :
6200 - accept :
6201 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6202 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6203 the rules evaluation.
6204
6205 - reject :
6206 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6207 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006208 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006209
6210 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6211 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6212 for changing the default action to a reject.
6213
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006214 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6215 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6216 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6217 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006218 period.
6219
6220 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6221
6222 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6223
6224
6225tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6226 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6228 no | no | yes | yes
6229 Arguments :
6230 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6231 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6232 as explained at the top of this document.
6233
6234 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6235
6236
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006237timeout check <timeout>
6238 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6239 established.
6240
6241 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6242 yes | no | yes | yes
6243 Arguments:
6244 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6245 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6246 as explained at the top of this document.
6247
6248 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6249 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6250 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6251 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006252 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6253 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6254 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006255
6256 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6257 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6258
6259 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6260 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006261 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006262
6263 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6264 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6265 forget about it.
6266
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006267 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6268 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006269
6270
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006271timeout client <timeout>
6272timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6273 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6275 yes | yes | yes | no
6276 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006277 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006278 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6279 as explained at the top of this document.
6280
6281 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6282 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6283 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6284 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6285 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6286 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6287 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6288 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006289 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006290 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006291 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6292 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6293 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006294
6295 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6296 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6297 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6298 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6299 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6300 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6301
6302 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6303 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6304 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6305
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006306 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006307
6308
6309timeout connect <timeout>
6310timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6311 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6313 yes | no | yes | yes
6314 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006315 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006316 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6317 as explained at the top of this document.
6318
6319 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006320 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006321 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006322 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006323 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6324 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006325
6326 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6327 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6328 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6329 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6330 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6331 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6332
6333 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6334 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6335 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6336
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006337 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6338 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006339
6340
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006341timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6342 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6344 yes | yes | yes | yes
6345 Arguments :
6346 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6347 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6348 as explained at the top of this document.
6349
6350 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6351 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6352 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6353 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6354 once the request has started to present itself.
6355
6356 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6357 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6358 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6359 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6360 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6361
6362 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6363 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6364 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6365 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6366
6367 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6368 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6369 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6370 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6371 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006372 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006373
6374 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6375 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6376 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6377 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6378
6379 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6380
6381
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006382timeout http-request <timeout>
6383 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006385 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006386 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006387 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006388 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6389 as explained at the top of this document.
6390
6391 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6392 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6393 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6394 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6395 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6396 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6397 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6398 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6399
6400 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6401 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006402 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6403 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006404
6405 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6406 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6407 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6408 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6409 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6410
6411 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006412 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6413 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6414 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006415
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006416 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006417
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006418
6419timeout queue <timeout>
6420 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6422 yes | no | yes | yes
6423 Arguments :
6424 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6425 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6426 as explained at the top of this document.
6427
6428 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6429 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6430 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6431 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6432 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6433
6434 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6435 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6436 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6437 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6438
6439 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6440
6441
6442timeout server <timeout>
6443timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6444 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6446 yes | no | yes | yes
6447 Arguments :
6448 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6449 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6450 as explained at the top of this document.
6451
6452 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6453 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6454 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6455 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6456 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6457 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6458 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6459
6460 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6461 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6462 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6463 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6464 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006465 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006466 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006467 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
6468 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
6469 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
6470 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006471
6472 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6473 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6474 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6475 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6476 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6477 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6478
6479 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6480 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6481 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6482
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006483 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006484
6485
6486timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006487 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6489 yes | yes | yes | yes
6490 Arguments :
6491 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6492 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6493 as explained at the top of this document.
6494
6495 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6496 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6497 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6498
6499 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6500 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6501 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6502 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006503 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006504
6505 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6506
6507
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006508timeout tunnel <timeout>
6509 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
6510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6511 yes | no | yes | yes
6512 Arguments :
6513 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6514 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6515 as explained at the top of this document.
6516
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006517 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006518 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
6519 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
6520 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
6521 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
6522 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
6523 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
6524 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
6525 specified.
6526
6527 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6528 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6529 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
6530 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
6531 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
6532
6533 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6534 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6535 forget about it.
6536
6537 Example :
6538 defaults http
6539 option http-server-close
6540 timeout connect 5s
6541 timeout client 30s
6542 timeout client 30s
6543 timeout server 30s
6544 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
6545
6546 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
6547
6548
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006549transparent (deprecated)
6550 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006552 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006553 Arguments : none
6554
6555 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6556 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6557 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6558 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6559 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6560 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6561 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6562 appropriate server.
6563
6564 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6565
6566 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6567 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6568
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006569 See also: "option transparent"
6570
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006571unique-id-format <string>
6572 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6574 yes | yes | yes | no
6575 Arguments :
6576 <string> is a log-format string.
6577
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006578 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6579 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6580 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6581 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006582
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006583 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6584 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6585 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6586 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6587 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6588 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6589 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6590 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006591
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006592 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6593 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006594
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006595 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006596
6597 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6598
6599 will generate:
6600
6601 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6602
6603 See also: "unique-id-header"
6604
6605unique-id-header <name>
6606 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6608 yes | yes | yes | no
6609 Arguments :
6610 <name> is the name of the header.
6611
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006612 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6613 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006614
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006615 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006616
6617 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6618 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6619
6620 will generate:
6621
6622 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6623
6624 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006625
6626use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6627use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006628 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6630 no | yes | yes | no
6631 Arguments :
6632 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6633
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006634 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006635
6636 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6637 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6638 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006639 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6640 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6641 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6642 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006643
6644 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6645 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6646 assign the backend.
6647
6648 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6649 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6650 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6651 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6652 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6653 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6654
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006655 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006656 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006657 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6658 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6659 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6660
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006661 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006662
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006663
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006664use-server <server> if <condition>
6665use-server <server> unless <condition>
6666 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6668 no | no | yes | yes
6669 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006670 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006671
6672 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6673
6674 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6675 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
6676 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
6677
6678 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
6679 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
6680 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
6681 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
6682 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
6683 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
6684 matches will assign the server.
6685
6686 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
6687 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
6688 with the next rules until one matches.
6689
6690 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
6691 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6692 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
6693 according to other persistence mechanisms.
6694
6695 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
6696 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
6697 stripped.
6698
6699 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
6700 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
6701 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
6702 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
6703
6704 Example :
6705 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
6706 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
6707 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
6708 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
6709 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
6710 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
6711 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
6712 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
6713 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
6714
6715 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
6716
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006717
67185. Bind and Server options
6719--------------------------
6720
6721The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
6722depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
6723settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
6724written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
6725described in this section.
6726
6727
67285.1. Bind options
6729-----------------
6730
6731The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
6732as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
6733no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
6734parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
6735while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
6736provided immediately after the setting name.
6737
6738The currently supported settings are the following ones.
6739
6740accept-proxy
6741 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
6742 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
6743 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
6744 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
6745 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
6746 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
6747 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
6748 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
6749 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
6750 usable.
6751
6752backlog <backlog>
6753 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
6754 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
6755
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02006756ecdhe <named curve>
6757 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
6758 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys and makes
6759 ECDHE cipher suites usable.
6760
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02006761cafile <cafile>
6762 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6763 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
6764 client's certificate.
6765
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02006766ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
6767 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6768 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
6769 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
6770 error is ignored.
6771
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006772ciphers <ciphers>
6773 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
6774 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
6775 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
6776 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
6777 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
6778
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02006779crlfile <cafile>
6780 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6781 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
6782 to verify client's certificate.
6783
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006784crt <cert>
6785 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6786 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
6787 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02006788 files into one. If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters
6789 present in this file are also loaded. If a directory name is used instead of a
6790 PEM file, then all files found in that directory will be loaded. This
6791 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
6792 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
6793 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN
6794 or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is
6795 used instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006796 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If no SNI is provided by the
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02006797 client or if the SSL library does not support TLS extensions, or if the client
6798 provides and SNI which does not match any certificate, then the first loaded
6799 certificate will be presented. This means that when loading certificates from
6800 a directory, it is highly recommended to load the default one first as a file.
6801 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006802
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02006803crt-ignore-err <errors>
6804 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6805 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
6806 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an
6807 error is ignored.
6808
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006809defer-accept
6810 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
6811 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
6812 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
6813 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
6814 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
6815 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
6816 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
6817 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
6818 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
6819 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
6820 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
6821
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02006822force-sslv3
6823 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6824 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
6825 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6826
6827force-tlsv10
6828 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6829 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6830
6831force-tlsv11
6832 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6833 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6834
6835force-tlsv12
6836 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6837 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6838
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006839gid <gid>
6840 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
6841 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
6842 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
6843 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
6844 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6845
6846group <group>
6847 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
6848 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
6849 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
6850 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
6851 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6852
6853id <id>
6854 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
6855 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
6856 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
6857 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
6858
6859interface <interface>
6860 Sets the name of the network interface to listen. This is currently only
6861 supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system interface, not an
6862 aliased interface. When specified, all addresses on the same line will only
6863 be accepted if the incoming packets physically come through the designated
6864 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to the same address
6865 if they are bound to different interfaces. Note that binding to a network
6866 interface requires root privileges. This parameter is only compatible with
6867 TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
6868
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02006869level <level>
6870 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
6871 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
6872 sockets. <level> can be one of :
6873 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
6874 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
6875 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
6876 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
6877 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
6878 counters).
6879 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
6880 all counters).
6881
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006882maxconn <maxconn>
6883 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
6884 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
6885 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
6886 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
6887 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
6888 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
6889 eat all memory.
6890
6891mode <mode>
6892 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
6893 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
6894 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
6895 UNIX sockets.
6896
6897mss <maxseg>
6898 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
6899 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
6900 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
6901 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
6902 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
6903 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
6904 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
6905 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
6906 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
6907 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
6908 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
6909
6910name <name>
6911 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
6912 page.
6913
6914nice <nice>
6915 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
6916 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
6917 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
6918 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
6919 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
6920 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
6921 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
6922 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
6923 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
6924 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
6925 one for an RDP socket.
6926
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02006927no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006928 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6929 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
6930 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02006931 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
6932 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006933
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02006934no-tls-tickets
6935 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6936 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
6937 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
6938 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
6939
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02006940no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006941 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02006942 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
6943 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
6944 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
6945 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006946
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02006947no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02006948 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02006949 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
6950 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
6951 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
6952 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02006953
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02006954no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02006955 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02006956 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
6957 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
6958 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
6959 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02006960
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006961ssl
6962 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6963 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
6964 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
6965 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
6966 to deciphered contents.
6967
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02006968tfo
6969 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.6. It
6970 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
6971 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
6972 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
6973 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
6974 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
6975 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
6976 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
6977 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
6978
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006979transparent
6980 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
6981 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
6982 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
6983 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
6984 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
6985 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
6986 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
6987 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
6988 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
6989 so check for support with your vendor.
6990
6991uid <uid>
6992 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
6993 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
6994 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
6995 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
6996 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6997
6998user <user>
6999 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7000 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7001 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7002 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7003 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7004
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007005verify [none|optional|required]
7006 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7007 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7008 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7009 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7010 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
7011 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from 'cafile'
7012 and optional CRLs from 'crlfile'. On verify failure the handshake is aborted,
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007013 regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly matches one
7014 of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007015
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020070165.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007017------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007018
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007019The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
7020which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
7021arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
7022settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
7023after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
7024Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
7025address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007026
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007027 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007028 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007029
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007030The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007031
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007032addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007033 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
7034 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
7035 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
7036 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
7037 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007038
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007039 Supported in default-server: No
7040
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007041backup
7042 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
7043 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
7044 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
7045 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
7046 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
7047 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007048
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007049 Supported in default-server: No
7050
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007051check
7052 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01007053 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
7054 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
7055 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
7056 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
7057 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
7058 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
7059 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
7060 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
7061 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
7062 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007063
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007064 Supported in default-server: No
7065
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007066check-send-proxy
7067 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
7068 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
7069 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
7070 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
7071 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
7072 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
7073 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
7074
7075 Supported in default-server: No
7076
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007077check-ssl
7078 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
7079 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
7080 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
7081 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
7082 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
7083 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
7084 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
7085 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
7086 See the "ssl" option for more information.
7087
7088 Supported in default-server: No
7089
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007090ciphers <ciphers>
7091 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
7092 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
7093 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
7094 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
7095 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
7096 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
7097 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
7098 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
7099
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007100 Supported in default-server: No
7101
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007102cookie <value>
7103 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
7104 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
7105 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
7106 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
7107 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
7108 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
7109 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
7110
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007111 Supported in default-server: No
7112
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02007113disabled
7114 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
7115 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
7116 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
7117 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
7118 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
7119
7120 Supported in default-server: No
7121
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007122error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007123 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
7124 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
7125 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007126
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007127 Supported in default-server: Yes
7128
7129 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007130
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007131fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007132 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
7133 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
7134 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
7135
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007136 Supported in default-server: Yes
7137
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007138force-sslv3
7139 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7140 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
7141 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7142
7143 Supported in default-server: No
7144
7145force-tlsv10
7146 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7147 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7148
7149 Supported in default-server: No
7150
7151force-tlsv11
7152 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7153 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7154
7155 Supported in default-server: No
7156
7157force-tlsv12
7158 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7159 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7160
7161 Supported in default-server: No
7162
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007163id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007164 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
7165 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
7166 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007167
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007168 Supported in default-server: No
7169
7170inter <delay>
7171fastinter <delay>
7172downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007173 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
7174 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
7175 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
7176 between checks depending on the server state :
7177
7178 Server state | Interval used
7179 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7180 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
7181 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7182 Transitionally UP (going down), |
7183 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7184 or yet unchecked. |
7185 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7186 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7187 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007188
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007189 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
7190 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
7191 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
7192 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
7193 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
7194 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
7195 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
7196 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
7197 servers.
7198
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007199 Supported in default-server: Yes
7200
7201maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007202 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
7203 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
7204 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
7205 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
7206 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
7207 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
7208 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
7209 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
7210
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007211 Supported in default-server: Yes
7212
7213maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007214 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
7215 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
7216 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
7217 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
7218 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
7219 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
7220 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
7221
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007222 Supported in default-server: Yes
7223
7224minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007225 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
7226 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
7227 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
7228 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
7229 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
7230 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007231 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007232 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007233
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007234 Supported in default-server: Yes
7235
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007236no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007237 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
7238 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007239 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007240
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007241 Supported in default-server: No
7242
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007243no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007244 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007245 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7246 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007247 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7248 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007249
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007250 Supported in default-server: No
7251
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007252no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007253 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007254 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7255 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007256 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7257 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007258
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007259 Supported in default-server: No
7260
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007261no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007262 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007263 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7264 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007265 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7266 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007267
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007268 Supported in default-server: No
7269
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09007270non-stick
7271 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
7272 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
7273 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
7274
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007275 Supported in default-server: No
7276
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007277observe <mode>
7278 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
7279 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
7280 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
7281 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
7282 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
7283 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01007284 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007285
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007286 Supported in default-server: No
7287
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007288 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
7289
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007290on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007291 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
7292 Currently, four modes are available:
7293 - fastinter: force fastinter
7294 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
7295 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
7296 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
7297 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
7298
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007299 Supported in default-server: Yes
7300
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007301 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
7302
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007303on-marked-down <action>
7304 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
7305 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007306 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
7307 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
7308 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
7309 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
7310 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
7311 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
7312 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
7313 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007314
7315 Actions are disabled by default
7316
7317 Supported in default-server: Yes
7318
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007319on-marked-up <action>
7320 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
7321 Currently one action is available:
7322 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
7323 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
7324 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
7325 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
7326 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
7327 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
7328 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
7329 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
7330
7331 Actions are disabled by default
7332
7333 Supported in default-server: Yes
7334
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007335port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007336 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
7337 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
7338 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
7339 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
7340 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
7341 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
7342
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007343 Supported in default-server: Yes
7344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007345redir <prefix>
7346 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
7347 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
7348 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
7349 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
7350 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
7351 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
7352 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
7353 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007354 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007355 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
7356 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
7357 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
7358 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
7359 loop between the client and HAProxy!
7360
7361 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
7362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007363 Supported in default-server: No
7364
7365rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007366 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
7367 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
7368 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
7369
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007370 Supported in default-server: Yes
7371
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007372send-proxy
7373 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
7374 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
7375 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
7376 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
7377 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
7378 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
7379 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
7380 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
7381 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007382 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
7383 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
7384 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
7385 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
7386 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007387
7388 Supported in default-server: No
7389
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007390slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007391 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
7392 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
7393 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
7394 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
7395 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
7396 parameters :
7397
7398 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
7399 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
7400
7401 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
7402 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
7403 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
7404 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
7405
7406 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
7407 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
7408 seen as failed.
7409
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007410 Supported in default-server: Yes
7411
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007412source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007413source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007414source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007415 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
7416 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
7417 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
7418 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
7419
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007420 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
7421 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
7422 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7423 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7424 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7425 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7426 server.
7427
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007428 Supported in default-server: No
7429
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007430ssl
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007431 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. At
7432 the moment, server certificates are not checked, so this is prone to man in
7433 the middle attacks. The real intended use is to permit SSL communication
7434 with software which cannot work in other modes over networks that would
7435 otherwise be considered safe enough for clear text communications. When this
7436 option is used, health checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there
7437 is a "port" or an "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a
7438 different location. See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
7439
7440 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007441
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007442track [<proxy>/]<server>
7443 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7444 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7445 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7446 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7447 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7448
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007449 Supported in default-server: No
7450
7451weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007452 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7453 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7454 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007455 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7456 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7457 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7458 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7459 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7460 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007461
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007462 Supported in default-server: Yes
7463
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007464
74656. HTTP header manipulation
7466---------------------------
7467
7468In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7469response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7470request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7471which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7472against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7473to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7474passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7475headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7476never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7477
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007478There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7479(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7480rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7481messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7482in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007483happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007484add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7485normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7486
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007487This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7488in section 4.2 :
7489
7490 - reqadd <string>
7491 - reqallow <search>
7492 - reqiallow <search>
7493 - reqdel <search>
7494 - reqidel <search>
7495 - reqdeny <search>
7496 - reqideny <search>
7497 - reqpass <search>
7498 - reqipass <search>
7499 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7500 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7501 - reqtarpit <search>
7502 - reqitarpit <search>
7503 - rspadd <string>
7504 - rspdel <search>
7505 - rspidel <search>
7506 - rspdeny <search>
7507 - rspideny <search>
7508 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7509 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7510
7511With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7512is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7513parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7514prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7515Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7516
7517 \t for a tab
7518 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7519 \n for a new line (LF)
7520 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7521 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7522 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7523 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7524 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7525
7526The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7527portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7528above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7529regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
75309 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7531is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7532
7533The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7534after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7535
7536Notes related to these keywords :
7537---------------------------------
7538 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7539 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7540 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7541
7542 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7543 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7544 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7545
7546 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7547 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7548 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7549 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7550 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7551
7552 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7553 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7554 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7555 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7556 useless headers before adding new ones.
7557
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007558 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007559 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7560
7561 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7562 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7563 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7564
7565 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7566 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007567 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007568
7569
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010075707. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7571------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007572
7573The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7574content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7575from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7576simple :
7577
7578 - define test criteria with sets of values
7579 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7580
7581The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7582
7583In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7584
7585 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7586
7587This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7588Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7589and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7590an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7591of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7592
7593ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7594'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7595which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7596
7597There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7598performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7599
7600The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7601
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007602 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7603 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007604 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7605
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007606The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7607specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7608possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007609multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7610be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7611needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7612space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7613match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7614lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7615duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007616to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceding it. For
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007617instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007618
7619 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7620
7621In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7622the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7623case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7624too.
7625
7626Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7627a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7628ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7629
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007630Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007631
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007632 - integers or integer ranges
7633 - strings
7634 - regular expressions
7635 - IP addresses and networks
7636
7637
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020076387.1. Matching integers
7639----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007640
7641Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7642that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7643expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7644may be omitted.
7645
7646For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7647unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7648representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7649
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007650As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7651two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7652instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7653ranges and operators.
7654
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007655For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007656operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7657Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7658of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007659
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007660Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007661
7662 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7663 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7664 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7665 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7666 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7667
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007668For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007669
7670 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7671
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007672This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7673
7674 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7675
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020076777.2. Matching strings
7678---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007679
7680String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7681exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7682characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7683string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7684to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007685before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007686
7687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020076887.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7689-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007690
7691Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7692they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7693possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7694passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7695the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007696the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7697match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007698
7699
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020077007.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007701----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007702
7703IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7704netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7705within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007706host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007707difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7708at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7709does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7710parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007711
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007712IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
7713Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
7714trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
7715IPv6 patterns.
7716
7717HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
7718following situations :
7719 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
7720 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
7721 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
7722 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
7723 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
7724 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
7725 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
7726 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
7727 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
7728 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
7729
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007730
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077317.5. Available matching criteria
7732--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007733
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077347.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7735------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007736
7737A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7738analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007739addresses and ports, as well as internal values independent on the stream.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007740
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007741always_false
7742 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7743 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7744
7745always_true
7746 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7747 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7748
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007749avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007750avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007751 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7752 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7753 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7754 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7755 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7756 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7757 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7758 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7759 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7760 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7761 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007762
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007763be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007764be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007765 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7766 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7767 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7768 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7769 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007770
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007771be_id <integer>
7772 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7773 backend it was called.
7774
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007775be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007776be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007777 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7778 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7779 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7780 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7781 sucking of an online dictionary).
7782
7783 Example :
7784 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7785 backend dynamic
7786 mode http
7787 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7788 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007789
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007790connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007791connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007792 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007793 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007794 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7795
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007796 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7797 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007798
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007799 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007800 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7801 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7802 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7803 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7804 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007805 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007806
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007807 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7808 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7809 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7810 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007811
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007812dst <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007813 Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be
7814 used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007815
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007816dst_conn <integer>
7817 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7818 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7819 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7820 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7821 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7822 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7823
7824dst_port <integer>
7825 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7826 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7827
7828fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007829fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007830 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7831 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7832 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7833 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7834 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7835 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7836 criteria.
7837
7838fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007839 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007840 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007841
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007842fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007843fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007844 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7845 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7846 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7847 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7848 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7849 the rate to go down below the limit.
7850
7851 Example :
7852 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7853 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7854 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7855 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7856 frontend mail
7857 bind :25
7858 mode tcp
7859 maxconn 100
7860 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7861 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7862 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7863 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007864
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007865nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007866nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007867 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7868 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7869 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7870 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7871 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007872
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007873queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007874queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007875 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7876 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7877 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7878 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7879 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7880 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7881 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7882
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007883sc1_bytes_in_rate
7884sc2_bytes_in_rate
7885 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7886 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7887 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7888
7889sc1_bytes_out_rate
7890sc2_bytes_out_rate
7891 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7892 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7893 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7894
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007895sc1_clr_gpc0
7896sc2_clr_gpc0
7897 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
7898 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
7899 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
7900 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
7901 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
7902 was verified :
7903
7904 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7905 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7906 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7907 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7908 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
7909 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7910 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7911
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007912sc1_conn_cnt
7913sc2_conn_cnt
7914 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7915 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7916
7917sc1_conn_cur
7918sc2_conn_cur
7919 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7920 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7921 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7922
7923sc1_conn_rate
7924sc2_conn_rate
7925 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7926 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7927 See also src_conn_rate.
7928
7929sc1_get_gpc0
7930sc2_get_gpc0
7931 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7932 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7933
7934sc1_http_err_cnt
7935sc2_http_err_cnt
7936 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
7937 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
7938 See also src_http_err_cnt.
7939
7940sc1_http_err_rate
7941sc2_http_err_rate
7942 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
7943 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
7944 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
7945 src_http_err_rate.
7946
7947sc1_http_req_cnt
7948sc2_http_req_cnt
7949 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7950 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7951 src_http_req_cnt.
7952
7953sc1_http_req_rate
7954sc2_http_req_rate
7955 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7956 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
7957 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7958 src_http_req_rate.
7959
7960sc1_inc_gpc0
7961sc2_inc_gpc0
7962 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
7963 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
7964 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
7965 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
7966 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
7967 when a first ACL was verified :
7968
7969 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7970 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
7971 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7972
7973sc1_kbytes_in
7974sc2_kbytes_in
7975 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
7976 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7977 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7978 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
7979
7980sc1_kbytes_out
7981sc2_kbytes_out
7982 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
7983 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7984 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7985 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
7986
7987sc1_sess_cnt
7988sc2_sess_cnt
7989 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
7990 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
7991 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
7992 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007993 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007994 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
7995
7996sc1_sess_rate
7997sc2_sess_rate
7998 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
7999 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
8000 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
8001 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
8002 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008003 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008004
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008005so_id <integer>
8006 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
8007
8008src <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008009 Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit
8010 access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level
8011 source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008012
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008013src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008014src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008015 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8016 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8017 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008018 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008019
8020src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008021src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008022 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
8023 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8024 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008025 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008026
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008027src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
8028src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
8029 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8030 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8031 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
8032 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
8033 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
8034 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
8035
8036 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8037 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8038 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8039 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
8040 acl save src_clr_gpc0
8041 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8042 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8043
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008044src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008045src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008046 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8047 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8048 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008049 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008050
8051src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008052src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008053 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
8054 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
8055 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008056 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008057
8058src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008059src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008060 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
8061 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8062 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008063 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008064
8065src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008066src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008067 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8068 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8069 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008070 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008071
8072src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008073src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008074 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
8075 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8076 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008077 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008078
8079src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008080src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008081 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
8082 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
8083 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
8084 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008085 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008086
8087src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008088src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008089 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8090 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8091 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008092 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008093
8094src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008095src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008096 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8097 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8098 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
8099 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008100 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008101
8102src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008103src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008104 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8105 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8106 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
8107 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
8108 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
8109 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
8110
8111 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8112 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008113 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008114
8115src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008116src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008117 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
8118 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8119 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8120 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008121 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008122
8123src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008124src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008125 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
8126 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8127 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8128 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008129 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008130
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008131src_port <integer>
8132 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008133
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008134src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008135src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008136 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8137 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
8138 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
8139 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008140 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008141
8142src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008143src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008144 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8145 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8146 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
8147 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008148 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008149
8150src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008151src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008152 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008153 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
8154 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008155 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
8156 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
8157 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008158 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008159
8160 Example :
8161 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
8162 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
8163 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
8164 listen ssh
8165 bind :22
8166 mode tcp
8167 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008168 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008169 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
8170 server local 127.0.0.1:22
8171
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008172srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02008173 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
8174 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
8175 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
8176 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
8177
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01008178srv_id <integer>
8179 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
8180
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02008181srv_is_up(<server>)
8182srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
8183 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
8184 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
8185 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
8186 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
8187 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
8188 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
8189 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
8190 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
8191
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008192table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008193table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008194 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
8195 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
8196
8197table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008198table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008199 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
8200 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
8201 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
8202
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008203
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020082047.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
8205---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008206
8207A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
8208during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008209through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
8210keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008211
Emeric Brunb4354082012-09-28 17:28:03 +02008212client_crt
8213 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008214 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brunb4354082012-09-28 17:28:03 +02008215
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008216is_ssl
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008217 Returns true when the incoming connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
8218 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
8219 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008220
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008221rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8222 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8223 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8224 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008225 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8226 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8227 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008228
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008229req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008230 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008231 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
8232 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
8233 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
8234 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
8235 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
8236 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
8237
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008238req_proto_http
8239 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
8240 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008241 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008242 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
8243 using TCP request content inspection rules.
8244
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008245req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008246req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008247 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
8248 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
8249 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
8250 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
8251 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
8252 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
8253 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
8254 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
8255
8256req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008257req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008258 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
8259 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
8260 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
8261 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
8262 cookies.
8263
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008264req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8265 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8266 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8267 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008268 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8269 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8270 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008271
8272req_ssl_sni <string>
8273 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8274 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8275 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
8276 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
8277 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
8278 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
8279 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008280 hello (type 1), like in the example below. Note that this only applies to raw
8281 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008282 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008283 option. See also "ssl_sni" below.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008284
8285 Examples :
8286 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
8287 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8288 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
8289 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
8290 default_backend bk_sorry_page
8291
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008292req_ssl_ver <decimal>
8293 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
8294 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
8295 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
8296 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
8297 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
8298 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008299 with TCP request content inspection. Note that this only applies to raw
8300 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008301 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008302 option.
8303
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008304ssl_has_sni
8305 This is used to check for presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008306 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
8307 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
8308 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8309 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008310
8311ssl_sni <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008312 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8313 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8314 sent by the client, matching the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8315 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008316 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8317 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded.
8318 See also "ssl_sni_end" and "ssl_sni_req" below. This requires that the SSL
8319 library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008320
8321ssl_sni_end <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008322 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8323 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8324 sent by the client, ending like the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8325 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008326 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8327 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8328 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8329 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008330
8331ssl_sni_req <regex>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008332 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8333 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8334 sent by the client, matching the specified regex. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8335 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008336 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8337 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8338 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8339 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008340
Emeric Brun3603fbe2012-09-28 18:35:15 +02008341ssl_verify_caerr <errorID>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008342 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8343 layer and the ID of the first error detected during verify at depth > 0 match
8344 the errorID.
Emeric Brun3603fbe2012-09-28 18:35:15 +02008345
8346ssl_verify_caerr_depth <depth>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008347 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8348 layer and the depth of the first error detected during verify match the
8349 depth.
Emeric Brun3603fbe2012-09-28 18:35:15 +02008350
8351ssl_verify_crterr <errorID>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008352 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8353 layer and the ID of the first error detected during verify at depth == 0
8354 match the errorID.
Emeric Brun3603fbe2012-09-28 18:35:15 +02008355
Emeric Brunc68af8d2012-09-28 18:14:24 +02008356ssl_verify_result <errorID>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008357 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8358 layer and the verify result match the errorID.
Emeric Brunc68af8d2012-09-28 18:14:24 +02008359
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02008360wait_end
8361 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
8362 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
8363 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
8364 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
8365 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
8366 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
8367 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
8368 inspection.
8369
8370 Examples :
8371 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
8372 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
8373 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
8374
8375 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
8376 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
8377 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
8378 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
8379 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
8380 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
8381 tcp-request content reject
8382
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008383
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083847.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
8385--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008386
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008387A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008388application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
8389read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
8390than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
8391
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008392base <string>
8393 Returns true when the concatenation of the first Host header and the path
8394 part of the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the
8395 question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be used to match known
8396 files in virtual hosting environments, such as "www.example.com/favicon.ico".
8397 See also "path" and "uri".
8398
8399base_beg <string>
8400 Returns true when the base (see above) begins with one of the strings. This
8401 can be used to send certain directory names to alternative backends. See also
8402 "path_beg".
8403
8404base_dir <string>
8405 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8406 slashes in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "url_dir" and
8407 "path_dir" instead.
8408
8409base_dom <string>
8410 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8411 in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "path_dom" and "url_dom"
8412 instead.
8413
8414base_end <string>
8415 Returns true when the base (see above) ends with one of the strings. This may
8416 be used to control file name extension, though "path_end" is cheaper.
8417
8418base_len <integer>
8419 Returns true when the base (see above) length matches the values or ranges
8420 specified. This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8421
8422base_reg <regex>
8423 Returns true when the base (see above) matches one of the regular
8424 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8425 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg", "url_reg"
8426 and all "base_" criteria.
8427
8428base_sub <string>
8429 Returns true when the base (see above) contains one of the strings. It can be
8430 used to detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See
8431 also "base_dir".
8432
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008433cook(<name>) <string>
8434 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
8435 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
8436 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
8437 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
8438 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
8439 sent by the server.
8440
8441 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
8442 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
8443 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
8444
8445 cook(profile) silver gold
8446
8447cook_beg(<name>) <string>
8448 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
8449 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8450 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8451
8452cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
8453 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
8454 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
8455 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
8456 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
8457 server.
8458
8459cook_dir(<name>) <string>
8460 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8461 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8462 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
8463 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
8464 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8465
8466cook_dom(<name>) <string>
8467 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8468 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
8469 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8470 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8471
8472cook_end(<name>) <string>
8473 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
8474 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8475 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8476
8477cook_len(<name>) <integer>
8478 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
8479 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8480 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
8481 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
8482 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8483
8484cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
8485 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
8486 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
8487 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
8488 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8489 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8490
8491cook_sub(<name>) <string>
8492 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
8493 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8494 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8495
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02008496cook_val(<name>) <integer>
8497 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which
8498 matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server
8499 based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not
8500 match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8501 scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8502
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008503hdr <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008504hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008505 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
8506 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
8507 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
8508 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008509 If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only
8510 this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from
8511 the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8512 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr()
8513 variant for response headers sent by the server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008514
8515 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008516 match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008517 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
8518
8519 hdr(Connection) -i close
8520
8521hdr_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008522hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008523 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
8524 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
8525 response headers sent by the server.
8526
8527hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008528hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008529 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
8530 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
8531 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
8532 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
8533 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
8534 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
8535 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8536
8537hdr_dir <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008538hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008539 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8540 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8541 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
8542 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
8543 headers sent by the server.
8544
8545hdr_dom <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008546hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008547 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8548 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
8549 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
8550 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
8551 server.
8552
8553hdr_end <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008554hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008555 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
8556 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
8557 response headers sent by the server.
8558
8559hdr_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008560hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address>
8561 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8562 matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For
8563 or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008564 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8565
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008566hdr_len <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008567hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008568 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
8569 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8570 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
8571 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8572
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008573hdr_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008574hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008575 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008576 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
8577 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
8578 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
8579 response headers sent by the server.
8580
8581hdr_sub <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008582hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008583 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
8584 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
8585 response headers sent by the server.
8586
8587hdr_val <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008588hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008589 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
8590 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
8591 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
8592 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8593
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008594http_auth(<userlist>)
8595http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008596 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
8597 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
8598 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
8599 of specified groups.
8600
8601 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
8602
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02008603http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02008604 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
8605 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
8606 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
8607 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
8608
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008609method <string>
8610 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
8611 already check for most common methods.
8612
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008613path <string>
8614 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
8615 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
8616 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
8617
8618path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008619 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
8620 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008621
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008622path_dir <string>
8623 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8624 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8625 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8626 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
8627
8628path_dom <string>
8629 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8630 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
8631 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
8632
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008633path_end <string>
8634 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
8635 control file name extension.
8636
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008637path_len <integer>
8638 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
8639 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8640
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008641path_reg <regex>
8642 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8643 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
8644 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
8645
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008646path_sub <string>
8647 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8648 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
8649 "path_dir".
8650
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +02008651payload(<offset>,<length>) <string>
8652 Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the
8653 request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the
8654 strings.
8655
8656payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
8657 Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
8658 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
8659 the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of
8660 the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
8661 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
8662
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008663req_ver <string>
8664 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
8665 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
8666
8667status <integer>
8668 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
8669 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
8670 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
8671
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008672url <string>
8673 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008674 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL. See also "base".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008675
8676url_beg <string>
8677 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008678 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme. See also
8679 "base_beg".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008680
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008681url_dir <string>
8682 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8683 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8684 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8685 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
8686
8687url_dom <string>
8688 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8689 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
8690 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
8691
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008692url_end <string>
8693 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
8694 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008695
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008696url_ip <address>
8697 Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP
8698 request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local
8699 network. It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008700
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008701url_len <integer>
8702 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
8703 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8704
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008705url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008706 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
8707 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008708 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008709 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008710
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008711url_reg <regex>
8712 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8713 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008714 than other methods. See also "base_reg", "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008715
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008716url_sub <string>
8717 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8718 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008719
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008720urlp(<name>) <string>
8721 Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the
8722 parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive.
8723
8724 The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter
8725 matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values.
8726
8727urlp_beg(<name>) <string>
8728 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings.
8729 This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a
8730 protocol scheme.
8731
8732urlp_dir(<name>) <string>
8733 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings
8734 either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename
8735 or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of
8736 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub".
8737
8738urlp_dom(<name>) <string>
8739 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8740 in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching
8741 in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding
8742 prefixes. See also "urlp_sub".
8743
8744urlp_end(<name>) <string>
8745 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings.
8746
8747urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008748 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8749 which matches one of the specified addresses.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008750
8751urlp_len(<name>) <integer>
8752 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values
8753 or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8754
8755urlp_reg(<name>) <regex>
8756 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular
8757 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8758 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all
8759 "urlp_" criteria.
8760
8761urlp_sub(<name>) <string>
8762 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It
8763 can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See
8764 also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria.
8765
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +02008766urlp_val(<name>) <integer>
8767 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" starts with a number matching
8768 the values or ranges specified. Note that the absence of the parameter does
8769 not match anything. Integers are unsigned so it is not possible to match
8770 negative data.
8771
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008772
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020087737.6. Pre-defined ACLs
8774---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008775
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008776Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
8777every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008778order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008780ACL name Equivalent to Usage
8781---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008782FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008783HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008784HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
8785HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008786HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
8787HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
8788HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
8789HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
8790LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008791METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
8792METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
8793METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
8794METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
8795METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
8796METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008797RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008798REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008799TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008800WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
8801---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008802
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008803
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088047.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
8805----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008806
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008807Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
8808combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008809
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008810 - AND (implicit)
8811 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
8812 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008813
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008814A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008815
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008816 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008817
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008818Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
8819indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008820
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008821For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
8822"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
8823requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
8824is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008825
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008826 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8827 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
8828 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
8829 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008830
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008831To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
8832and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008833
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008834 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8835 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8836 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
8837 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008838
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008839 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
8840 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
8841 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
8842 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008843
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01008844It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
8845expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
8846be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008847the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01008848
8849 The following rule :
8850
8851 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8852 block if METH_POST missing_cl
8853
8854 Can also be written that way :
8855
8856 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
8857
8858It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
8859to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
8860simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
8861sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
8862good use is the following :
8863
8864 With named ACLs :
8865
8866 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8867 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8868 monitor fail if site_dead
8869
8870 With anonymous ACLs :
8871
8872 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
8873
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008874See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008875
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01008876
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010088777.8. Pattern extraction
8878-----------------------
8879
8880The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
8881response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
8882for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
8883
8884All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
8885"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
8886begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
8887arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
8888much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
8889equivalent used in ACLs.
8890
8891The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
8892
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008893 base This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the
8894 path part of the request, which starts at the first slash and
8895 ends before the question mark. It can be useful in virtual
8896 hosted environments to detect URL abuses as well as to improve
8897 shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size stick
8898 table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
8899 requested objects by host/path.
Emeric Brunb4354082012-09-28 17:28:03 +02008900 client_crt
8901 Returns 1 if a client certificate is present in an incoming
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008902 connection over SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise 0.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008903
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008904 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008905 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8906 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8907 according to RFC 4291.
8908
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008909 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
8910 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
8911 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008912 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8913 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8914 according to RFC 4291.
8915
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008916 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
8917 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
8918 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
8919 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
8920 type integer and only works with such tables.
8921
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008922 hdr(<name>[,<occ>])
8923 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
8924 request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as
8925 a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
8926 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
8927 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the
8928 last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01008929 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02008930
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008931 is_ssl This checks the transport layer used by incoming connection, and
8932 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
8933 layer, otherwise zero.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008934
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02008935 path This extracts the request's URL path (without the host part). A
8936 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
8937 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
8938 keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing caches, it would be
8939 wiser to use "url" instead.
8940
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008941 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008942 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
8943 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
8944 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
8945 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008946
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008947 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008948 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
8949 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
8950 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
8951 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
8952 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
8953 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
8954 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
8955 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008956
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008957 src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side,
8958 which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely
8959 that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost.
8960 It is of type integer and only works with such tables.
8961
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008962 ssl_has_sni This checks the transport layer used by incoming connection, and
8963 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
8964 layer and the client sent a Server Name Indication TLS extension,
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008965 otherwise zero. This requires that the SSL library is build with
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008966 support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008967
8968 ssl_sni This extracts the Server Name Indication field from an incoming
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008969 connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
8970 deciphered by haproxy. The result typically is a string matching
8971 the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must
8972 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8973 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008974
Emeric Brun3603fbe2012-09-28 18:35:15 +02008975 ssl_verify_caerr
8976 Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify at
8977 depth > 0 or 0 if no errors.
8978
8979 ssl_verify_caerr_depth
8980 Returns the depth of the first error detected during verify.
8981
8982 ssl_verify_crterr
8983 Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify at
8984 depth == 0 or 0 if no errors.
8985
Emeric Brunc68af8d2012-09-28 18:14:24 +02008986 ssl_verify_result
8987 Returns the verify result errorID when the incoming connection
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008988 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunc68af8d2012-09-28 18:14:24 +02008989
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02008990 url This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A
8991 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
8992 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
8993 keep them in caches. See also "path".
8994
8995 url_ip This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the
8996 host part is presented as an IP address. Its use is very
8997 limited. For instance, a monitoring system might use this field
8998 as an alternative for the source IP in order to test what path a
8999 given source address would follow, or to force an entry in a
9000 table for a given source address.
9001
9002 url_port This extracts the port part from the request's URL. It probably
9003 is totally useless but it was available at no cost.
9004
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009005 url_param(<name>[,<delim>])
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009006 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009007 the parameter string of the request and uses the corresponding
9008 value to match. Optionally, a delimiter can be provided. If not
9009 then the question mark '?' is used by default.
9010 A typical use is to get sticky session through url for cases
9011 where cookies cannot be used.
9012
9013 Example :
9014 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
9015 stick on url_param(PHPSESSIONID)
9016 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
9017 stick on url_param(JSESSIONID,;)
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09009018
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009019 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009020 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
9021 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
9022 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
9023 done if there is no msts cookie present.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009024
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009025 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
9026 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
9027 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
9028 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
9029 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
9030 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
9031 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009032
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009033 Example :
9034 listen tse-farm
9035 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
9036 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9037 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9038 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9039 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9040 persist rdp-cookie
9041 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
9042 # This is only useful makes sense if
9043 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
9044 stick-table type string size 204800
9045 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
9046 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9047 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009048
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009049 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
9050 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009051
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009052 cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009053 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009054 "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header
9055 from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A
9056 typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile
9057 use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession"
9058 does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
9059 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009060
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009061 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009062
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009063 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009064 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the
9065 "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and
9066 responses. This keyword will disappear soon.
9067
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009068 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
9069 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
9070 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
9071 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
9072 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009073
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009074 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009075
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009076
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009077The currently available list of transformations include :
9078
9079 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
9080 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9081 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9082
9083 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
9084 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9085 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9086
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009087 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01009088 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
9089 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
9090 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
9091 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9092
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009093
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090948. Logging
9095----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009096
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009097One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
9098provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
9099very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
9100provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
9101state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009102to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009103headers.
9104
9105In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
9106about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
9107send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
9108
9109 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
9110 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
9111 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
9112 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
9113 at the termination.
9114
9115The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
9116allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
9117as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
9118while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
9119real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
9120delay.
9121
9122
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091238.1. Log levels
9124---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009125
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009126TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009127source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009128HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
9129in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
9130track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
9131syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
9132about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009133
9134
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091358.2. Log formats
9136----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009137
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009138HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009139and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
9140slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
9141options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009142
9143 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
9144 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
9145 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
9146 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
9147 extents.
9148
9149 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
9150 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
9151 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
9152 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
9153 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
9154
9155 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
9156 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
9157 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
9158 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
9159 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
9160
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009161 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
9162 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
9163 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
9164 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
9165
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009166 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
9167
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009168Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
9169specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
9170field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
9171servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
9172always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
9173identifier.
9174
9175Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
9176 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
9177 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
9178 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
9179 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
9180
9181
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091828.2.1. Default log format
9183-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009184
9185This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
9186as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
9187format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
9188
9189 Example :
9190 listen www
9191 mode http
9192 log global
9193 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9194
9195 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
9196 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
9197 (www/HTTP)
9198
9199 Field Format Extract from the example above
9200 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
9201 2 'Connect from' Connect from
9202 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
9203 4 'to' to
9204 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
9205 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
9206
9207Detailed fields description :
9208 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
9209 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
9210 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
9211 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
9212 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9213 and processed the connection.
9214 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
9215
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009216In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
9217"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
9218connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
9219
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009220It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
9221will eventually disappear.
9222
9223
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092248.2.2. TCP log format
9225---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009226
9227The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
9228is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
9229information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
9230counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
9231emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
9232environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
9233the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
9234sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009235specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
9236not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
9237fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
9238marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009239
9240 Example :
9241 frontend fnt
9242 mode tcp
9243 option tcplog
9244 log global
9245 default_backend bck
9246
9247 backend bck
9248 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9249
9250 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
9251 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
9252 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
9253
9254 Field Format Extract from the example above
9255 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
9256 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
9257 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
9258 4 frontend_name fnt
9259 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
9260 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
9261 7 bytes_read* 212
9262 8 termination_state --
9263 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
9264 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9265
9266Detailed fields description :
9267 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009268 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9269 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9270 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9271 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9272 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009273
9274 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009275 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9276 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9277 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009278
9279 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
9280 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
9281 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
9282 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
9283
9284 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9285 and processed the connection.
9286
9287 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9288 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9289 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
9290 applications.
9291
9292 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9293 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9294 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9295 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
9296 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
9297
9298 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9299 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9300 See "Timers" below for more details.
9301
9302 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9303 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9304 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
9305 "Timers" below for more details.
9306
9307 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9308 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9309 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9310 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9311 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9312 details.
9313
9314 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
9315 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
9316 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
9317 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
9318 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
9319
9320 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9321 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9322 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
9323 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
9324 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
9325 for more details.
9326
9327 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009328 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009329 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
9330 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
9331 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009332 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009333
9334 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9335 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9336 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9337 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9338 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9339 caused by a denial of service attack.
9340
9341 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9342 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9343 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9344 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9345 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9346 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9347 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9348 denial of service attack.
9349
9350 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9351 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9352 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9353 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9354 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9355 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9356 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9357 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
9358 be processed than on other servers.
9359
9360 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9361 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9362 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9363 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9364 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9365 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9366 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9367 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9368 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9369 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9370 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9371 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9372 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9373
9374 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9375 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9376 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9377 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9378 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9379 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9380 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9381 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9382
9383 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9384 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9385 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9386 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9387 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9388 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9389 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9390 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9391 occurs.
9392
9393
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093948.2.3. HTTP log format
9395----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009396
9397The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
9398is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
9399the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
9400are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
9401emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
9402generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
9403"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
9404which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009405frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
9406is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009407
9408Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
9409slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
9410with a star ('*') after the field name below.
9411
9412 Example :
9413 frontend http-in
9414 mode http
9415 option httplog
9416 log global
9417 default_backend bck
9418
9419 backend static
9420 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9421
9422 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9423 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9424 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009425 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009426
9427 Field Format Extract from the example above
9428 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
9429 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
9430 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
9431 4 frontend_name http-in
9432 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
9433 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
9434 7 status_code 200
9435 8 bytes_read* 2750
9436 9 captured_request_cookie -
9437 10 captured_response_cookie -
9438 11 termination_state ----
9439 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
9440 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9441 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
9442 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
9443 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009444
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009445
9446Detailed fields description :
9447 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009448 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9449 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9450 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9451 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9452 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009453
9454 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009455 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9456 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9457 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009458
9459 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
9460 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
9461 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
9462 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
9463 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
9464
9465 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9466 and processed the connection.
9467
9468 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9469 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9470 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
9471
9472 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9473 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9474 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9475 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
9476 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
9477 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
9478
9479 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
9480 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
9481 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
9482 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
9483 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
9484 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
9485
9486 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9487 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9488 See "Timers" below for more details.
9489
9490 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9491 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9492 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
9493 below for more details.
9494
9495 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
9496 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
9497 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
9498 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
9499 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
9500 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
9501 for more details.
9502
9503 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9504 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9505 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9506 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9507 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9508 details.
9509
9510 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
9511 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
9512 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
9513
9514 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
9515 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
9516 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
9517 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
9518 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
9519 overflowing.
9520
9521 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
9522 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
9523 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
9524 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
9525 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
9526 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
9527 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
9528 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9529
9530 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
9531 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
9532 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
9533 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
9534 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
9535 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
9536 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
9537 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9538
9539 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9540 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9541 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
9542 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
9543 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
9544 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
9545 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
9546
9547 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009548 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009549 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
9550 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
9551 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009552 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009553 system.
9554
9555 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9556 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9557 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9558 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9559 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9560 caused by a denial of service attack.
9561
9562 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9563 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9564 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9565 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9566 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9567 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9568 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9569 denial of service attack.
9570
9571 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9572 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9573 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9574 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9575 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9576 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9577 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9578 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
9579 processed than on other servers.
9580
9581 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9582 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9583 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9584 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9585 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9586 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9587 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9588 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9589 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9590 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9591 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9592 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9593 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9594
9595 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9596 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9597 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9598 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9599 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9600 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9601 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9602 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9603
9604 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9605 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9606 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9607 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9608 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9609 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9610 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9611 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9612 occurs.
9613
9614 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
9615 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
9616 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
9617 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
9618 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
9619 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
9620 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
9621 cookies" below for more details.
9622
9623 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
9624 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
9625 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
9626 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
9627 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
9628 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
9629 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
9630 and cookies" below for more details.
9631
9632 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
9633 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
9634 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
9635 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
9636 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
9637 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
9638 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
9639 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
9640
9641
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020096428.2.4. Custom log format
9643------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009644
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009645The directive log-format allows you to custom the logs in http mode and tcp
9646mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009647
9648HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
9649Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
9650separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
9651prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
9652
9653Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
9654variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
9655string formats ("Q").
9656
9657Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
9658HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
9659
9660Flags are :
9661 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009662 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009663
9664 Example:
9665
9666 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
9667 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
9668
9669At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
9670
9671 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %st\ %B\ %cc\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009672 %cs\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009673
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009674the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009675
9676 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}Ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %st\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %Cp\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009677 %ms\ %f\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009678 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %cc\ %cs\ \%hrl\ %hsl
9679
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009680and the default TCP format is defined this way :
9681
9682 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
9683 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
9684
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009685Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
9686
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009687 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9688 | H | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
9689 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9690 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
9691 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9692 | | %B | bytes_read | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009693 | | %Ci | client_ip | IP |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009694 | | %Cp | client_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009695 | | %Bi | backend_source_ip | IP |
William Lallemandb7ff6a32012-03-02 14:35:21 +01009696 | | %Bp | backend_source_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009697 | | %Fi | frontend_ip | IP |
9698 | | %Fp | frontend_port | numeric |
9699 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009700 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009701 | | %Si | server_IP | IP |
9702 | | %Sp | server_port | numeric |
9703 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009704 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
9705 | * | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
9706 | * | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009707 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009708 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
9709 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
9710 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
9711 | | %b | backend_name | string |
9712 | | %bc | beconn | numeric |
9713 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
9714 | * | %cc | captured_request_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009715 | * | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009716 | * | %cs | captured_response_cookie | string |
9717 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
9718 | | %fc | feconn | numeric |
9719 | * | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
9720 | * | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
9721 | * | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
9722 | * | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
9723 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009724 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009725 | * | %r | http_request | string |
9726 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
9727 | | %s | server_name | string |
9728 | | %sc | srv_conn | numeric |
9729 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
9730 | * | %st | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009731 | | %t | date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009732 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009733 | * | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009734 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009735
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009736*: mode http only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009737
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097388.3. Advanced logging options
9739-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009740
9741Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
9742just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
9743options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
9744for more information about their usage.
9745
9746
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097478.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
9748------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009749
9750It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
9751haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
9752commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
9753monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
9754ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
9755
9756 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
9757 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
9758 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
9759 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
9760
9761 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
9762 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
9763 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
9764 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
9765 such as other load-balancers.
9766
9767 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
9768 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
9769 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
9770
9771
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097728.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
9773----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009774
9775The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
9776what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
9777or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
9778"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
9779just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
9780log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
9781after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
9782is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
9783with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
9784with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
9785
9786
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097878.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
9788------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009789
9790Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
9791for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
9792"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
9793retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
9794raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
9795a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
9796file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
9797you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
9798"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
9799
9800
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098018.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
9802--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009803
9804Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
9805multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
9806them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
9807"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
9808logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
9809error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
9810and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
9811too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
9812useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
9813alternative.
9814
9815
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098168.4. Timing events
9817------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009818
9819Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
9820reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
9821the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
9822frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
9823mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
9824
9825 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
9826 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
9827 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
9828 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
9829 the client closes prematurely or times out.
9830
9831 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
9832 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
9833 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
9834 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
9835 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
9836
9837 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
9838 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
9839 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
9840 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
9841 connection never established.
9842
9843 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
9844 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
9845 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
9846 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
9847 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
9848 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
9849 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
9850 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
9851 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
9852 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
9853 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
9854
9855 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
9856 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
9857 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
9858 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
9859 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
9860
9861 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
9862
9863 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
9864 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
9865 negative.
9866
9867These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
9868protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
9869that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009870due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009871close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
9872session has been aborted on timeout.
9873
9874Most common cases :
9875
9876 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
9877 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
9878 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
9879 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
9880 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
9881 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
9882 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
9883 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
9884 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02009885 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
9886 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
9887 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009888
9889 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
9890 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
9891 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
9892 of ms on remote networks.
9893
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009894 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
9895 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
9896 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009897
9898 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
9899 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
9900 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
9901 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
9902 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
9903 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
9904 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
9905 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
9906 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
9907 to the server until another one is released.
9908
9909Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
9910
9911 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
9912 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
9913 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
9914
9915 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
9916 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
9917 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
9918
9919 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
9920 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
9921 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
9922 flags.
9923
9924 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
9925 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
9926 Check the session termination flags, then check the
9927 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
9928 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
9929 the client connection was maintained open.
9930
9931 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
9932 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
9933 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
9934 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
9935
9936
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020099378.5. Session state at disconnection
9938-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009939
9940TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
9941"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
99422-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
9943each of which has a special meaning :
9944
9945 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
9946 session to terminate :
9947
9948 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
9949
9950 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
9951 server explicitly refused it.
9952
9953 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
9954 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
9955 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
9956 error in server response which might have caused information leak
9957 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
9958 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
9959
9960 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
9961 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
9962 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
9963 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
9964 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
9965
9966 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
9967 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
9968 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
9969 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
9970 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
9971
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +09009972 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
9973 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
9974
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009975 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
9976 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
9977 backup connections when going up.
9978
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +02009979 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
9980
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009981 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
9982 send or receive data.
9983
9984 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
9985 send or receive data.
9986
9987 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
9988 with nothing left in the buffers.
9989
9990 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
9991
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01009992 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009993 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
9994
9995 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
9996 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
9997 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
9998 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
9999 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
10000
10001 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
10002 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
10003
10004 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
10005 server (HTTP only).
10006
10007 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
10008
10009 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
10010 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
10011 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
10012
10013 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
10014 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
10015 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
10016
10017 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
10018
10019 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
10020 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
10021
10022 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
10023 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
10024 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
10025
10026 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
10027 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020010028 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
10029 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010030
10031 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
10032 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
10033 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
10034 another server.
10035
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010036 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010037 server.
10038
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010039 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
10040 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
10041 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
10042 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10043
10044 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
10045 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
10046 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
10047 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10048
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020010049 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
10050 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
10051 "use-server" rule).
10052
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010053 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10054
10055 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
10056 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
10057
10058 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
10059
10060 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
10061 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
10062 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
10063
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010064 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
10065 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
10066 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
10067 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
10068 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
10069
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010070 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
10071
10072 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
10073 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
10074
10075 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
10076
10077 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10078
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010079The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
10080was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010081helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
10082starvation, attacks, etc...
10083
10084The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
10085alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
10086easier finding and understanding.
10087
10088 Flags Reason
10089
10090 -- Normal termination.
10091
10092 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
10093 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
10094 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
10095 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
10096
10097 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
10098 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
10099 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
10100 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
10101 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
10102 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010103
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010104 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10105 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010106 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010107
10108 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
10109 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
10110 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
10111
10112 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
10113 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
10114 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
10115 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
10116 the server takes too long to respond.
10117
10118 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
10119 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
10120 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
10121 long a time to respond.
10122
10123 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
10124 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
10125 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
10126 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
10127 and the client.
10128
10129 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
10130 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
10131 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
10132 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
10133 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
10134 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
10135
10136 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
10137 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010138 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
10139 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
10140 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
10141 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010142
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010143 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010144 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
10145 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
10146 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
10147 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
10148 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
10149
10150 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
10151 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
10152 503 or 504 here.
10153
10154 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
10155 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
10156 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
10157 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
10158 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
10159
10160 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10161 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010162 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010163 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
10164 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
10165
10166 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
10167 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
10168 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
10169 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
10170 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
10171 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
10172 between haproxy and the server.
10173
10174 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
10175 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
10176 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
10177 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
10178 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
10179 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
10180 solution is to fix the application.
10181
10182 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
10183 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
10184 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
10185 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
10186 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
10187 external attacks.
10188
10189 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
10190 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010191 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010192 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
10193 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
10194
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010195 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
10196 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
10197 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
10198 the client.
10199
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010200 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
10201 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
10202 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
10203 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010204 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
10205 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
10206 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
10207 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
10208 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010209
10210 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
10211 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
10212 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
10213 returned an HTTP 403 error.
10214
10215 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
10216 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
10217 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
10218 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
10219
10220 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
10221 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
10222 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
10223 only be solved by proper system tuning.
10224
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010225The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
10226persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
10227important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
10228re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
10229
10230 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
10231
10232 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10233 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
10234 set on a GET request.
10235
10236 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
10237 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010238 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010239 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
10240
10241 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
10242 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
10243 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
10244
10245 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10246 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
10247 already got a cookie.
10248
10249 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10250 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
10251 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
10252 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
10253 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
10254
10255 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10256 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10257 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10258
10259 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
10260 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10261 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10262
10263 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
10264 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
10265
10266 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
10267 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
10268 then advertised in the response.
10269
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010270
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102718.6. Non-printable characters
10272-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010273
10274In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
10275consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
10276converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
10277prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
10278being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
10279escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
10280is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
10281'}' when logging headers.
10282
10283Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
10284issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
10285containing spaces is "User-Agent".
10286
10287Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
10288the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
10289performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
10290
10291
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102928.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
10293---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010294
10295Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
10296achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010297section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010298cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
10299the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
10300the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010301locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010302not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
10303user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
10304a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
10305wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
10306
10307 Examples :
10308 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
10309 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
10310
10311 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
10312 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
10313
10314
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103158.8. Capturing HTTP headers
10316---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010317
10318Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
10319proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
10320the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
10321server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
10322
10323Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
10324response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010325section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010326
10327It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010328time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
10329appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010330are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
10331and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
10332follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
10333request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
10334in the logs.
10335
10336 Example :
10337 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
10338 listen proxy-out
10339 mode http
10340 option httplog
10341 option logasap
10342 log global
10343 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
10344
10345 # log the name of the virtual server
10346 capture request header Host len 20
10347
10348 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
10349 capture request header Content-Length len 10
10350
10351 # log the beginning of the referrer
10352 capture request header Referer len 20
10353
10354 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
10355 capture response header Server len 20
10356
10357 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
10358 capture response header Content-Length len 10
10359
10360 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
10361 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
10362
10363 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
10364 capture response header Via len 20
10365
10366 # log the URL location during a redirection
10367 capture response header Location len 20
10368
10369 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
10370 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
10371 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10372 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
10373 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
10374
10375 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10376 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10377 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10378 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010379 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010380
10381 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10382 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10383 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10384 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
10385 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010386 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010387
10388
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103898.9. Examples of logs
10390---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010391
10392These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
10393them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
10394reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
10395
10396 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
10397 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10398 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10399
10400 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
10401 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
10402
10403 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
10404 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
10405 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10406
10407 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
10408 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
10409
10410 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
10411 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10412 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
10413
10414 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010415 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010416 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
10417 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
10418
10419 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
10420 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
10421 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
10422
10423 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
10424 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010425 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010426 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
10427 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
10428 to return the 502 and not the server.
10429
10430 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010431 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010432
10433 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
10434 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
10435 Nothing was sent to any server.
10436
10437 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
10438 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
10439
10440 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
10441 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
10442 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
10443 send a 408 return code to the client.
10444
10445 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
10446 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
10447
10448 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
10449 5 seconds ("c----").
10450
10451 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
10452 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010453 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010454
10455 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010456 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010457 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
10458 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
10459 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
10460 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
10461 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010462
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010463
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104649. Statistics and monitoring
10465----------------------------
10466
10467It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
10468mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
10469CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
10470Unix socket.
10471
10472
104739.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010474---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010475
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010010476The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
10477page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
10478
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010479 0. pxname: proxy name
10480 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
10481 for server)
10482 2. qcur: current queued requests
10483 3. qmax: max queued requests
10484 4. scur: current sessions
10485 5. smax: max sessions
10486 6. slim: sessions limit
10487 7. stot: total sessions
10488 8. bin: bytes in
10489 9. bout: bytes out
10490 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010491 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010492 12. ereq: request errors
10493 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010494 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010495 15. wretr: retries (warning)
10496 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010010497 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010498 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
10499 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
10500 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
10501 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
10502 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
10503 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
10504 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
10505 25. qlimit: queue limit
10506 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
10507 27. iid: unique proxy id
10508 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
10509 29. throttle: warm up status
10510 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
10511 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010512 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020010513 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
10514 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
10515 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010516 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010517 UNK -> unknown
10518 INI -> initializing
10519 SOCKERR -> socket error
10520 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
10521 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
10522 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
10523 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
10524 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
10525 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10526 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10527 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
10528 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
10529 disable-on-404
10530 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10531 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10532 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010533 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
10534 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010535 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
10536 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
10537 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
10538 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
10539 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
10540 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010541 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
10542 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
10543 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
10544 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010545 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
10546 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010547
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010548
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200105499.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010550-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010551
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010552The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010553must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
10554is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
10555a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
10556risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
10557followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
10558given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
10559then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
10560to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010561
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010562It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
10563on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
10564own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010565
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010566clear counters
10567 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
10568 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
10569 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
10570 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
10571 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10572
10573clear counters all
10574 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
10575 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
10576 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
10577
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010578clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
10579 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
10580
10581 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
10582 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
10583 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
10584 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
10585 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
10586 later after the session ends is usual enough.
10587
10588 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
10589
10590 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
10591 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
10592 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
10593 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
10594 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
10595 the ACLs :
10596
10597 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10598 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10599 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10600 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10601 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10602 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10603
10604 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010605 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
10606 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010607
10608 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010609 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010610 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010611 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10612 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10613 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10614 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010615
10616 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10617
10618 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010619 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010620 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10621 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010622 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10623 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10624 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010625
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010626disable frontend <frontend>
10627 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
10628 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
10629 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
10630 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
10631 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
10632 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
10633 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
10634 on the stats page.
10635
10636 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10637 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10638
10639 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10640 level "admin".
10641
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010642disable server <backend>/<server>
10643 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
10644 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
10645 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
10646 during the maintenance.
10647
10648 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
10649 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
10650
10651 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010652 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010653
10654 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10655 level "admin".
10656
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010657enable frontend <frontend>
10658 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
10659 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
10660 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
10661 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
10662 which was disabled.
10663
10664 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10665 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10666
10667 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10668 level "admin".
10669
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010670enable server <backend>/<server>
10671 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
10672 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
10673
10674 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010675 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010676
10677 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10678 level "admin".
10679
10680get weight <backend>/<server>
10681 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
10682 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
10683 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
10684 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
10685 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010686 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010687
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010688help
10689 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
10690 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010691
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010692prompt
10693 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
10694 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
10695 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
10696 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
10697 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
10698 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
10699 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
10700 command.
10701
10702quit
10703 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010704
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020010705set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020010706 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
10707 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
10708 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
10709 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
10710 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020010711 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
10712 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10713
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020010714set maxconn global <maxconn>
10715 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
10716 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
10717 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
10718 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
10719 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
10720 setting.
10721
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020010722set rate-limit connections global <value>
10723 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
10724 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
10725 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
10726 is passed in number of connections per second.
10727
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020010728set table <table> key <key> data.<data_type> <value>
10729 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
10730 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
10731 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
10732 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
10733 IP address or affect its quality of service.
10734
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010735set timeout cli <delay>
10736 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
10737 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
10738 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
10739
10740set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
10741 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
10742 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
10743 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
10744 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
10745 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
10746 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
10747 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
10748 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
10749 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
10750 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
10751 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
10752 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
10753 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010754 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010755
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010756show errors [<iid>]
10757 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
10758 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010759 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
10760 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
10761 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010762
10763 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
10764 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
10765 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
10766 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
10767 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
10768 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
10769 are reported too.
10770
10771 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
10772 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
10773 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
10774 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
10775 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
10776 code.
10777
10778 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
10779 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
10780 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
10781 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
10782 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
10783 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
10784 line.
10785
10786 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010787 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10788 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010789 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
10790 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
10791
10792 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
10793 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
10794 00038 Location: blah\r\n
10795 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
10796 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
10797 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
10798 00204+ minal\r\n
10799 00211 \r\n
10800
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010801 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010802 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
10803 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
10804 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
10805 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
10806 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
10807 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010808
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010809show info
10810 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
10811
10812show sess
10813 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010814 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
10815 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10816
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010010817show sess <id>
10818 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
10819 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10820 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
10821 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
10822 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
10823 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010824
10825show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
10826 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
10827 possible to dump only selected items :
10828 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
10829 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
10830 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
10831 for example:
10832 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
10833 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
10834 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
10835
10836 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010837 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
10838 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010839 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
10840 Release_date: 2009/09/23
10841 Nbproc: 1
10842 Process_num: 1
10843 (...)
10844
10845 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
10846 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
10847 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
10848 (...)
10849 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
10850
10851 $
10852
10853 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
10854 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
10855 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
10856 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010857 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010858
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010859show table
10860 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
10861 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
10862 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
10863 entries currently in use.
10864
10865 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010866 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010867 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
10868 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010869
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010870show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010871 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
10872 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
10873 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010874 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
10875
10876 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
10877 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
10878 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
10879 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
10880 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
10881
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010882 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10883 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10884 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10885 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10886 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10887 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10888
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010889
10890 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010891 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
10892 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010893
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010894 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010895 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010896 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010897 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10898 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10899 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10900 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010901
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010902 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010903 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010904 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10905 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010906
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010907 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
10908 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010909 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010910 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10911 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010912
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010913 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
10914 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010915 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010916 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10917 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
10918
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010919 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
10920 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
10921 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
10922 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
10923 time goes, the average event rate drops.
10924
10925 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
10926 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
10927 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010928 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
10929 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010930 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
10931 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020010932
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010933shutdown frontend <frontend>
10934 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
10935 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
10936 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
10937 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
10938 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
10939 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
10940 once it is terminated.
10941
10942 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10943 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10944
10945 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10946 level "admin".
10947
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020010948shutdown session <id>
10949 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
10950 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10951 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
10952 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
10953 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
10954 flag in the logs.
10955
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020010956shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
10957 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
10958 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
10959 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
10960 'K' flag in the logs.
10961
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010962/*
10963 * Local variables:
10964 * fill-column: 79
10965 * End:
10966 */